Lexicon Baby Monitor MC 12 User Manual

MC-12 Digital Controller  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby, Pro Logic’” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby  
Laboratories. Surround EX is a jointly developed technology of THX and Dolby, Laboratories, Inc., and is a registered trademark of  
Dolby. Used under authorization.  
THX, Ultra and Ultra2 are trademarks of THX Ltd., which may be registered in some jurisdictions. All rights reserved.  
Lexicon Inc.  
3 Oak Park  
Bedford, MA 01730-1413 USA  
Manufactured under license from Lucasfilm Ltd. U.S. Patent Nos. 5,043,970; 5,189,703; and/or 5,222,056. European Patent No.  
0323830. Other U.S. and foreign patents pending. Lucasfilm is a trademark of Lucasfilm Ltd.  
Tel  
Fax  
781-280-0300  
781-280-0490  
DTS, DTS-ES, Neo:6, and DTS 96/24 are trademarks of Digital Theater Systems, Inc.  
SACD is a trademark of Sony Electronics, Inc.  
www.harmanspecialtygroup.com  
Customer Service  
SHARC is a Trademark of Analog Devices, Inc.  
Telephone:  
Sales Fax:  
Service Fax:  
781-280-0300  
781-280-0495  
781-280-0499  
Lexicon, Logic 7 and the L7 logo are registered trademarks of Harman International Industries, Inc. U.S. Patent Nos. D454,553;  
D454,860; 5,796,844; 5,870,480 and other worldwide patents issued and pending.  
© 2005 Harman International Industries, Incorporated. All rights reserved.  
This document should not be construed as a commitment on the part of Harman Specialty Group. The information it contains is  
subject to change without notice. Harman Specialty Group assumes no responsibility for errors that may appear within this  
document.  
Part No. 070-14773 | Rev 4 | 05/05  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Lexicon  
DOCUMENTATION CONVENTIONS  
This document contains general safety, installation and operation instructions for the MC-12 and MC-12 Balanced Digital Controllers. It is  
important to read this user guide before attempting to use the product. Pay particular attention to safety instructions.  
The following symbols are used in the document:  
Appears on the component to indicate the pres-  
DVD1  
NAME  
EDIT INPUT NAME  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
ence of uninsulated, dangerous voltage inside  
the enclosure voltage that may be sufficient to  
constitute a risk of shock.  
Represents a menu path. The menu items in gray boxes must be  
selected with the remote control Menu arrow to access the  
menu or menu item in the black box. For example, the SETUP,  
INPUTS, and DVD1 menu items must be selected to open the  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP menu.  
Appears on the component to indicate impor-  
tant operating and maintenance instructions in  
the accompanying literature.  
The DVD1 INPUT SETUP menu is used here as an example and will  
continue to be used as an example throughout this document.  
Whenever it appears, any other INPUT SETUP menu may be substi-  
tuted. Likewise, whenever the DVD1 input appears as a step in a  
menu path, any other input may be substituted.  
Calls attention to a procedure, practice, condi-  
tion or the like that, if not correctly performed  
or adhered to, could result in injury or death.  
WARNING  
Calls attention to a procedure, practice, condi-  
tion or the like that, if not correctly performed  
or adhered to, could result in damage or  
destruction to part or all of the product.  
CAUTION!  
Note:  
Calls attention to information that is essential to  
highlight.  
This document uses the term MC-12 to refer to both the MC-12 and MC-12 Balanced Digital Controllers unless otherwise specified.  
This document uses the term DTS-(ES) to indicate that DTS-ES encoding may or may not be present in the input source.  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Introduction  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Lexicon  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Introduction  
ENGLISH  
DEUTSCH  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
WICHTIGE SICHERHEITSHINWEISE  
1
2
3
4
Save these instructions for later use.  
1
2
3
Bewahren Sie diese Anleitungen zur späteren Benutzung auf.  
Follow all instructions and warnings marked on the unit.  
Follow all instructions and warnings marked on the unit.  
Befolgen Sie alle Anleitungen und alle Warnhinweise auf dem Gerät  
Betreiben Sie das Gerät immer mit der korrekten Netzspannung. Angaben über den  
Strombedarf entnehmen Sie bitte den Betriebsanweisungen des Herstellers. Bei  
unterschiedlichen Betriebsspannungen kann die Verwendung anderer Netzkabel und/  
oder Anschlußstecker erforderlich werden.  
Always use with the correct line voltage. Refer to the manufacturer’s operating  
instructions for power requirements. Be advised that different operating voltages  
may require the use of a different line cord and/or attachment plug.  
4
5
Bauen Sie das Gerät nie in ein unbelüftetes Rack oder direkt über Wärme erzeu-  
genden Geräten wie Verstärkern ein. Beachten Sie die in der Produktspezifikation  
aufgeführte maximale Umgebungstemperatur für den Betrieb.  
5
6
Do not install the unit in an unventilated rack, or directly above heat producing  
equipment such as power amplifiers. Observe the maximum ambient operating  
temperature listed in the product specification.  
Schlitze und Öffnungen in der Box dienen der Belüftung, damit das Gerät zuverläs-  
sig läuft und sich nicht überhitzt. Diese Öffnungen dürfen nicht abgedeckt oder  
blockiert werden. Auch dürfen keine Gegenstände in sie hineingesteckt werden.  
Verschütten Sie niemals Flüssigkeiten, gleich welcher Art, auf das Gerät.  
Slots and openings on the case are provided for ventilation; to ensure reliable oper-  
ation and prevent it from overheating, these openings must not be blocked or cov-  
ered. Never push objects of any kind through any of the ventilation slots. Never  
spill liquid of any kind on the unit.  
6
7
Schließen Sie niemals Stromausgänge des Audioverstärkers direkt an das Gerät  
an.  
7
8
Never attach audio power amplifier outputs directly to any of the unit’s connectors.  
To prevent shock or fire hazard, do not expose the unit to rain or moisture, or oper-  
ate it where it will be exposed to water.  
Zur Vermeidung von elektrischen Schlägen oder Brandgefahr darf das Gerät weder  
Regen noch Feuchtigkeit ausgesetzt oder an Orten betrieben werden, wo es mit  
Wasser in Berührung kommen kann.  
9
Do not attempt to operate the unit if it has been dropped, damaged, exposed to liq-  
uids, or if it exhibits a distinct change in performance indicating the need for ser-  
vice.  
8
9
Versuchen Sie nie, das Gerät zu betreiben, wenn es fallen gelassen, beschädigt  
oder Flüssigkeiten ausgesetzt wurde oder wenn ein deutlicher Leistungsunter-  
schied zu verzeichnen ist, der darauf hinweist, dass es gewartet werden muss.  
10 This unit should only be opened by qualified service personnel. Removing covers  
will expose you to hazardous voltages.  
Dieser Apparat sollte nur von qualifizierten Fachleuten geöffnet werden. Das Abne-  
hmen von Abdeckungen setzt Sie gefährlichen Spannungen aus.  
This triangle, which appears on your component, alerts you to the presence  
of uninsulated, dangerous voltage inside the enclosure…voltage that may be  
sufficient to constitute a risk of shock.  
Dieses Dreieck, welches auf Ihrem Bauteil angebracht ist, warnt Sie vor dem  
Vorhandensein nicht isolierter gef hrlicher Spannung im Gerät. Diese Span-  
nung kann so hoch sein, dass das Risiko eines Stromschlags besteht.  
This triangle, which appears on your component, alerts you to important  
operating and maintenance instructions in this accompanying literature.  
Dieses Dreieck, welches auf Ihrem Bauteil angebracht ist, macht Sie auf  
wichtige Betriebs- und Wartungshinweise in diesen Hinweisen aufmerksam.  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Introduction  
Lexicon  
ESPAÑOL  
FRANÇAIS  
INSTRUCTIONS IMPORTANTES RELATIVES À LA  
SÉCURITÉ  
INSTRUCCIONES DE SEGURIDAD IMPORTANTES  
1
2
Guarde estas instrucciones para futuras referencias.  
1
2
Conservez ces instructions pour pouvoir vous y référer ultérieurement.  
Siga todas las instrucciones y tenga en cuenta las advertencias que aparecen en la  
unidad y en las instrucciones de funcionamiento.  
Suivez toutes ces instructions et tenez compte de tous les avertissements indiqués  
sur l’appareil et dans la documentation fournie avec l’appareil.  
3
Utilice siempre la tensión de línea correcta. Consulte las instrucciones del fabri-  
cante, donde se especifican los requisitos de alimentación. Tenga en cuenta que  
unas tensiones operativas diferentes pueden precisar de la utilización de difer-  
entes cables de alimentación y/o enchufes.  
3
4
5
Utilisez toujours la tension secteur correcte. Consultez les instructions du fabri-  
cant précisant les caractéristiques d’alimentation à respecter. Attention, le type de  
cordon secteur et/ou de prise secteur peut varier selon des tensions en vigueur  
dans l’installation.  
4
5
No instale la unidad en un rack sin ventilación, o directamente sobre equipos que  
generen calor, como amplificadores de potencia. Tenga en cuenta la temperatura  
operativa ambiental máxima que se detalla en las especificaciones del producto.  
N’installez pas l’appareil dans un Rack mal ventilé ou directement au-dessus d’un  
appareil dégageant de la chaleur comme un amplificateur de puissance. Respectez  
la température maximale de fonctionnement précisée dans les caractéristiques  
techniques.  
Las ranuras y aberturas del equipo son para su ventilación - para garantizar un fun-  
cionamiento fiable y evitar que la unidad se sobrecaliente, no bloquee, cubra o  
inserte objetos en las aberturas. No derrame nunca líquidos de ningún tipo sobre  
la unidad.  
Les ouvertures dans le boîtier assurent la bonne ventilation de l’appareil, évitent  
toute surchauffe et assurent le bon fonctionnement du système. Veillez à ne pas  
obstruer, couvrir ou insérer d’objets dans ces ouvertures. Veillez à ne pas ren-  
verser de liquide sur l’appareil.  
6
7
8
Nunca conecte directamente salidas de amplificadores de potencia de audio a nin-  
guno de los conectores de la unidad.  
6
7
Ne reliez jamais directement les sorties audio des amplificateurs de puissance aux  
connecteurs de l’appareil.  
Para evitar descargas eléctricas o incendios, no exponga la unidad a la humedad o  
la lluvia, ni la utilice donde pueda estar expuesta al agua.  
Afin d’éviter tout risque d’électrocution ou d’incendie, n’exposez pas l’appareil à la  
pluie ou à l’humidité ; ne l’utilisez pas dans des endroits exposés aux projections  
de liquides.  
No intente utilizar la unidad si ésta ha caído, se ha dañado, ha estado expuesta a  
líquidos, o si muestra un cambio importante en sus prestaciones, lo cual indicaría  
la necesidad de una reparación.  
8
9
N’essayez pas d’utiliser l’appareil si celui-ci est tombé, a été endommagé, exposé à  
des projections de liquides ou si vous constatez des dysfonctionnements nécessi-  
tant l’intervention d’un technicien spécialisé.  
9
Das Esta unidad deberá ser abierta únicamente por personal calificado. Si usted  
quita las coberturas se expondrá a voltajes peligrosos.  
Este triangulo, que aparece en su componente, alerta de la presencia de una  
tensi n peligrosa no aislada en el interior del equipo - una tensi n que puede  
ser suficiente como para constituir un riesgo de descarga el ctrica.  
Cet appareil ne doit être ouvert que par un personnel de service qualifié. En enle-  
vant les couvercles vous vous exposez à des tensions électriques dangereuses.  
Le symbole de l’ clair fl ch dans un triangle quilat ral sert alerter l’utilisateur  
sur la pr sence l’int rieur de l’appareil de tensions non isol es susceptibles  
de constituer un risque d’ lectrocution.  
Este triangulo, que aparece en su equipo, le alerta de instrucciones operati-  
vas y de mantenimiento importantes en los documentos que acompa an el  
producto.  
Le point d’exclamation dans un triangle quilat ral sert alerter l’utilisateur sur  
la pr sence de nombreuses instructions de maintenance dans le manuel  
fourni avec l’appareil.  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Introduction  
ITALIANO  
IMPORTANTI NORME DI SICUREZZA  
PORTUGUESE  
INSTRUÇÕES IMPORTANTES DE SEGURANÇA  
1
2
Conservare le presenti norme per l’utilizzo futuro.  
1
2
Guarde essas instruções para uso posterior.  
Seguire sempre tutte le istruzioni e gli avvertimenti segnati sull’unità e nelle istruz-  
ioni operative.  
Siga todas as instruções e fique atento aos avisos marcados na unidade e nas  
instruções de operação.  
3
4
5
Utilizzare sempre la corretta tensione di alimentazione. Fare riferimento al manuale  
del costruttore per le caratteristiche di alimentazione. Tensioni di rete diverse  
necessitano anche di un diverso cavo con spine differenti.  
3
4
5
Sempre use com a voltagem correta. Veja no manual de instruções do fabricante  
qual a alimentação necessária. Lembre-se que voltagens de operação diferentes  
podem precisar de um cabo ou plug diferentes.  
Non installare l’unità in un rack poco ventilato, o direttamente sopra apparecchia-  
ture che producono calore, come amplificatori di potenza. Controllare la massima  
temperatura ambientale di esercizio sulle specifiche tecniche del prodotto.  
Não instale a unidade em um suporte sem ventilação ou diretamente acima de  
equipamentos que produzam calor, como transformadores. Observe a temperatura  
ambiente máxima de operação indicada na especificação do produto.  
Fori ed aperture nei pannelli sono necessari per garantire un corretta ventilazione e  
prevenire surriscaldamenti. Queste aperture non devono essere coperte o ostruite.  
Non inserire oggetti di alcun tipo nei fori di ventilazione. Evitare il contatto con liq-  
uidi di qualsiasi genere.  
O revestimento da unidade é provido de fendas e aberturas para ventilação – para  
assegurar uma operação confiável e evitar que a unidade se superaqueça. Não blo-  
queie, cubra ou insira objetos nas aberturas. Nunca derrube líquido de qualquer  
espécie na unidade.  
6
7
8
Evitare di collegare le uscite di un amplificatore di potenza direttamente a qualsiasi  
connettore dell’unità.  
6
7
8
Nunca ligue saídas de amplificadores de áudio diretamente a qualquer dos conec-  
tores da unidade.  
Per evitare il rischio di scosse elettriche non esporre il prodotto a pioggia o umid-  
ità. Evitare l’uso dove possa essere esposto all’acqua.  
Para evitar danos de choque ou fogo, não exponha a unidade à chuva ou umidade,  
ou opere-a onde haja exposição à água.  
Non tentare di utilizzare il prodotto se è caduto, se è stato a contatto con liquidi, o  
mostra chiari segni di danneggiamento o cambio di prestazioni che indicano la  
necessità di assistenza tecnica.  
Não tente operar a unidade se ela for derrubada, danificada, exposta à líquidos ou  
apresente uma mudança de performance notável, indicando a necessidade de  
manutenção.  
9
Ogni intervento sull’unità va eseguito esclusivamente da personale qualificato. La  
rimozione della copertura comporta l’esposizione al pericolo di folgorazione.  
9
Esta unidade só deveria ser aberta através de pessoal de serviço qualificado.  
Removendo coberturas o exporão a voltagens perigosas.  
Il presente triangolo impresso sul componente avverte la presenza di ten-  
sioni pericolose non isolate all interno della copertura – tali tensioni rappre-  
sentano un pericolo di folgorazione.  
Esse triângulo que aparece no seu console, alerta para a presença de volta-  
gem perigosa e não isolada no recinto – voltagem que pode ser suficiente  
para constituir um risco de choque.  
Il presente triangolo impresso sul componente avverte l utente della pre-  
senza nella documentazione allegata di importanti istruzioni relative al funzi-  
onamento ed alla manutenzione.  
Esse triângulo ques aparece no seu console alerta para instruções impor-  
tantes de operação e manutenção neste manual.  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Introduction  
Lexicon  
DANSK  
SUOMI  
VIGTIG INFORMATION OM SIKKERHED  
TÄRKEITÄ TURVALLISUUSOHJEITA  
1
2
3
Gem denne vejledning til senere brug.  
Følg alle anvisninger og advarsler på apparatet.  
1
2
3
Säilytä nämä ohjeet tulevaa käyttöä varten.  
Seuraa kaikkia yksikköön merkittyjä ohjeita ja varoituksia.  
Apparatet skal altid tilsluttes den korrekte spænding. Der henvises til brugsanvis-  
ningen, der indeholder specifikationer for strømforsyning. Der gøres opmærksom  
på, at ved varierende driftsspændinger kan det blive nødvendigt at bruge andre led-  
nings- og/eller stiktyper.  
Käytä aina oikeaa verkkojännitettä. Tehovaatimukset selviävät valmistajan käyttöo-  
hjeista. Huomaa, että eri käyttöjännitteet saattavat vaatia toisenlaisen verkkojo-  
hdon ja/tai-pistokkeen käytön.  
4
5
Älä asenna yksikköä telineeseen jossa ei ole tuuletusta, tai välittömästi lämpöä tuo-  
tavien laitteiden, esim. tehovahvistimien, yläpuolelle.Ympäristön lämpötila  
käytössä ei saa ylittää tuotespesifikaation maksimilämpötilaa.  
4
5
Apparatet må ikke monteres i et kabinet uden ventilation eller lige over andet  
udstyr, der udvikler varme, f.eks. forstærkere. Den maksimale omgivelsestempera-  
tur ved drift, der står opført i specifikationerne, skal overholdes.  
Kotelo on varustettu tuuletusreiillä ja -aukoilla. Luotettavan toiminnan varmista-  
miseksi ja ylilämpenemisen välttämiseksi näitä aukkoja ei saa sulkea tai peittää.  
Mitään esineitä ei saa työntää tuuletusaukkoihin. Mitään nesteitä ei saa kaataa  
yksikköön.  
Der er ventilationsåbninger i kabinettet. For at sikre apparatets drift og hindre over  
phedning må disse åbninger ikke blokeres eller tildækkes. Stik aldrig noget ind  
igennem ventilationsåbningerne, og pas på aldrig at spilde nogen form for væske  
på apparatet.  
6
7
Älä kytke audiotehovahvistimen lähtöjä suoraan mihinkään yksikön liittimeen.  
6
7
Udgangsstik fra audioforstærkere må aldrig sættes direkte i apparatet.  
Sähköiskun ja palovaaran välttämiseksi yksikkö ei saa olla sateessa tai kosteassa,  
eikä sitä saa käyttää märässä ympäristössä.  
Apparatet må ikke udsættes for regn eller fugt og må ikke bruges i nærheden af  
vand for at undgå risiko for elektrisk stød og brand.  
8
9
Älä käytä yksikköä jos se on pudonnut, vaurioitunut, kostunut, tai jos sen suori-  
tuskyky on huomattavasti muuttunut, mikä vaatii huoltoa.  
8
9
Apparatet må aldrig bruges, hvis det er blevet stødt, beskadiget eller vådt, eller hvis  
ændringer i ydelsen tyder på, at det trænger til eftersyn.  
Yksikön saa avata vain laitteeseen perehtynyt huoltohenkilö. Kansien poisto  
altistaa sinut vaarallisille jännitteille.  
Dette apparat må kun åbnes af fagfolk. Hvis dækslet tages af, udsættes man for  
livsfarlig højspænding.  
Tämä kolmio, joka esiintyy komponentissasi, varoittaa sinua eristämättömän  
vaarallisen jännitteen esiintymisestä yksikön sisällä. Tämä jännite saattaa  
olla riittävän korkea aiheuttamaan sähköiskuvaaran.  
Denne mærkat på komponenten advarer om uisoleret, farlig spænding i  
apparatet - høj nok til at give elektrisk stød.  
Denne mærkat på komponenten advarer om vigtig driftsog vedligeholdsin-  
formation i den tilhørende litteratur.  
Tämä kolmio, joka esiintyy komponentissasi, kertoo sinulle, että tässä tuote-  
dokumentoinnissa esiintyy tärkeitä käyttö- ja ylläpito-ohjeita.  
viii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Introduction  
NORSK  
SVENSKA  
VIKTIG INFORMASJON OM SIKKERHET  
VIKTIGA SÄKERHETSFÖRESKRIFTER  
1
2
3
Ta vare på denne veiledningen for senere bruk.  
1
2
3
Spara dessa föreskrifter för framtida bruk.  
Följ alla anvisningar och varningar som anges på enheten.  
Følg alle anvisningene og advarslene som er angitt på apparatet.  
Apparatet skal alltid anvendes med korrekt spenning. Produktbeskrivelsen inne-  
holder spesifikasjoner for strømkrav. Vær oppmerksom på at det ved ulike drift-  
sspenninger kan være nødvendig å bruke en annen ledning- og/eller støpseltype.  
Använd alltid rätt nätspänning. Se tillverkarens bruksanvisningar för information  
om effektkrav. Märkväl, att andra matningsspänningar eventuellt kräver att en  
annan typs nätsladd och/eller kontakt används.  
4
5
Apparatet skal ikke monteres i skap uten ventilasjon, eller direkte over varmepro-  
duserende utstyr, som for eksempel kraftforsterkere. Den maksimale romtempera-  
turen som står oppgitt i produktbeskrivelsen, skal overholdes.  
4
5
Installera inte enheten i ett oventilerat stativ, eller direkt ovanför utrustningar som  
avger värme, t ex effektförstärkare. Se till att omgivningens temperatur vid drift inte  
överskrider det angivna värdet i produktspecifikationen.  
Apparatet er utstyrt med ventilasjonsåpninger. For at apparatet skal være pålitelig i  
bruk\ og ikke veropphetes, må disse åpningene ikke blokkeres eller tildekkes. Stikk  
aldri noe inn i ventilasjonsåpningene, og pass på at det aldri søles noen form for  
væske på apparatet.  
Behållaren är försedd med hål och öppningar för ventilering. För att garantera  
tillförlitlig funktion och förhindra överhettning får dessa öppningar inte blockeras  
eller täckas. Inga föremål får skuffas in genom ventilationshålen. Inga vätskor får  
spillas på enheten.  
6
7
Utgangsplugger fra audioforsterkere skal aldri koples direkte til apparatet.  
6
7
Anslut aldrig audioeffektförstärkarutgångar direkt till någon av enhetens kontakter.  
Unngå brannfare og elektrisk støt ved å sørge for at apparatet ikke utsettes for regn  
eller fuktighet og ikke anvendes i nærheten av vann.  
För att undvika elstöt eller brandfara får enheten inte utsättas för regn eller fukt,  
eller användas på ställen där den blir våt.  
8
9
Apparatet skal ikke brukes hvis det har blitt utsatt for støt, er skadet eller blitt vått,  
eller hvis endringer i ytelsen tyder på at det trenger service.  
8
9
Använd inte enheten om den har fallit i golvet, skadats, blivit våt, eller om dess pre-  
standa förändrats märkbart, vilket kräver service.  
Dette apparatet skal kun åpnes av fagfolk. Hvis dekselet fjernes, utsettes man for  
livsfarlig høyspenning.  
Enheten får öppnas endast av behörig servicepersonal. Farliga spänningar blir  
tillgängliga när locken tas bort.  
Komponenten er merket med denne trekanten, som er en advarsel om at det  
finnes uisolert, farlig spenning inne i kabinettet - høy nok til å utgjøre en fare  
for elektrisk støt.  
Denna triangel, som visas på din komponent, varnar dig om en oisolerad far-  
lig spänning inne i enheten. Denna spänning är eventuellt så hög att fara för  
elstöt föreligger.  
Komponenten er merket med denne trekanten, som betyr at den tilhørende  
litteraturen inneholder viktige opplysninger om drift og ved.  
Denna triangel, som visas på din komponent, anger att viktiga bruksanvisn-  
ingar och serviceanvisningar ingår i dokumentationen i fråga.  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Introduction  
Lexicon  
Unpacking and Inspection  
Contenu de Lemballage et Inspection  
After unpacking the unit, save all packing materials in case the unit  
ever needs to be shipped. Thoroughly inspect the modules and  
packing materials for signs of damage. Report any damage to the  
carrier at once; report equipment malfunction to the dealer.  
Après avoir ouvert l’emballage, conservez-le pour tout retour.  
Inspectez avec soin les modules et les matériaux d’emballage pour  
tout signe de dommage. Veuillez rapporter immédiatement les  
dommages auprès du transporteur. Les dysfonctionnements du  
matériel doivent être signalés à votre revendeur.  
Auspacken und Überprüfung  
Disimballaggio ed Ispezione  
Bewahren Sie nach dem Auspacken des Geräts das  
Verpackungsmaterial für den Fall auf, dass Sie das Gerät wieder  
versenden müssen. Überprüfen Sie die Module und die Verpackung  
sorgfältig auf Anzeichen von Beschädigung. Etwaige Schäden sind  
dem Transporteur unverzüglich anzuzeigen; Funktionsstörungen  
sind dem zuständigen Händler zu melden.  
Dopo aver disimballato l’unità, salvi tutto il materiale  
d’imballaggio, in caso Lei abbia bisogno di spedire l’unità. Ispezioni  
attentamente i moduli ed il materiale d’imballaggio per vedere se  
riportano segni di danno. Riporti subito ogni segno di danno al  
corriere; riferisca il malfunzionamento dell’attrezzatura al suo  
rivenditore.  
Desembalaje e Inspección  
Retirando a Embalagem e Inspecionando  
Después de desembalar la unidad, guarde todos los materiales de  
embalaje por si alguna vez transportar la unidad. Inspeccione con  
atención los módulos y los materiales de embalaje para comprobar  
que no muestren desperfectos. Informe inmediatamente de  
cualquier desperfecto al transportista; informe de cualquier  
problema de funcionamiento del equipo a su distribuidor.  
Depois de desembalar a unidade, guarde a embalagem caso  
precise enviar  
a
unidade para manutenção. Inspecione  
cuidadosamente o módulo e a embalagem procurando sinais de  
dano. Avise à loja qualquer tipo de dano ou mal funcionamento do  
equipamento.  
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
1
Getting Started  
About The MC-12 ...................................................................... 1-2  
Highlights ................................................................................................ 1-4  
Product Registration................................................................... 1-5  
Installation Considerations.......................................................... 1-5  
Remote Control Battery Installation ............................................ 1-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Getting Started  
Lexicon  
ABOUT THE MC-12  
Thank you for purchasing the MC-12 Digital Controller, a  
reference-quality, 12-channel audio and video control center with  
independent zone monitoring to provide control of input source  
selection in three zones at the same time. As flexible as it is  
powerful, the MC-12 includes 12 configurable inputs, each of  
which can be assigned to its 13 digital audio, 8 analog audio,  
5 composite video, 8 S-video, or 4 component video input  
connectors. The analog audio input connectors can be configured  
for stereo or 5.1-channel sources.  
The MC-12 also offers LIVE! (Lexicon Intelligent Variable  
Environment), designed to transform the way your listening room  
sounds with the live sound that is created within the room by the  
occupants of the room. LIVE! does not (nor is it meant to) work  
with pre-recorded material. LIVE! provides a realistic illusion of a  
larger, more reverberant listening space – ideal for musicians  
wishing to practice or perform with the sound of a larger venue.  
LIVE! is a unique, sophisticated reverberation system that uses a  
combination of microphones and digital signal processing (DSP) to  
enhance a room’s acoustics and create the illusion of a much larger  
space. When you engage in normal conversation, it seems as if you  
are in a large room. When you practice or perform with a musical  
instrument, it seems as if you are in a concert hall. Choose from one  
of three customizable presets to create an ambiance to liven up a  
party or amaze your friends.  
Beyond the standard 5.1-channel audio output connectors, the rear  
panel includes stereo rear and stereo subwoofer connectors, as well as  
stereo auxiliary connectors to provide even more audio channels. All  
Main Zone audio output connectors include 24-bit/96kHz D/A  
converters operating in dual differential mode. In addition, the MC-12  
Balanced includes balanced audio output connectors for all Main Zone  
and Zone 2 channels.  
In addition to Logic 7 and LIVE!, the MC-12 is also equipped with  
Dolby Digital Surround EX, Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Pro Logic II,  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx, DTS 96/24, DTS NEO:6, DTS-ES, THX Ultra2,  
and THX Surround EX decoding. THX Ultra2 Certification guarantees  
that the MC-12 meets the highest THX performance specifications.  
Inside and out, the MC-12 is designed to remain viable in a future  
of emerging technologies. Two RS-232 connectors are provided for  
serial control, one to perform flash-memory software upgrades and  
backup and restore configuration files, and another to support  
future expansion. Inside, two expansion slots are available for  
hardware upgrades, making it possible to more than quadruple the  
MC-12’s processing power.  
With four 32-bit floating-point SHARC™ digital signal processing  
(DSP) engines, the MC-12 offers unparalleled processing power.  
These DSP engines perform custom Lexicon processing such as  
Logic 7 decoding, bass enhancement, dialog enhancement, auto  
azimuth, 5-speaker enhancement, bass management, high-  
precision digital crossovers, and tone controls. This processing is  
available at sample rates up to 96kHz, with 24-bit resolution to  
retain top performance from all input sources and listening modes.  
A fifth DSP engine is dedicated to decoding multi-channel  
compressed audio sources.  
More than just an audio and video control center, the MC-12  
features the latest version of Lexicon’s critically acclaimed Logic 7  
decoding, which derives 7.1-channel output from stereo, 5.1-, and  
6.1-channel sources. Unlike other decoders, Logic 7 is compatible  
with all input sources and requires no special encoding. Because  
the improvement it provides is clearly audible, Logic 7 decoding is  
widely regarded as the finest available.  
1-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Getting Started  
High-precision 24-bit/96kHz A/D converters can be used to convert  
stereo and 5.1 analog audio input signals to digital signals,  
allowing the MC-12 to provide the benefits of precise digital signal  
processing without sacrificing signal integrity. Alternatively, stereo  
and 5.1 analog signals can bypass A/D conversion and internal  
processing to remain in the analog domain straight to the output  
connectors.  
Complementing its audio performance, the MC-12 features two  
broadcast-quality video switchers. An ultra-wide bandwidth  
component video switcher accepts analog component or RGB  
video signals, while a composite and S-video switcher accepts high-  
quality NTSC, PAL or SECAM video signals. The component video  
switcher can pass High-Definition TV (HDTV) signals, and Standard-  
Definition TV signals. Both switchers are designed to pass video  
signals without alteration or degradation.  
Digital audio input signals are processed through a two-stage  
phase lock loop for extremely low intrinsic jitter and high rejection.  
Lexicon’s proprietary auto azimuth technology corrects timing and  
level imbalances in stereo sources, ensuring exceptionally accurate  
playback of surround-encoded sources. A digital audio pass-  
through option is available for recording digital signals with a CD  
recorder or a similar component.  
An unparalleled processor, the MC-12 conveys the best in music  
and cinema with awesome power and leading-edge technological  
sophistication. Even the most demanding enthusiasts will be  
impressed with its exceptional performance. The MC-12 is a must-  
have addition for any high-quality home theater.  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Started  
Lexicon  
HIGHLIGHTS  
12 channels  
4 component video input connectors with  
full HDTV compatibility  
THX Ultra2 and THX Surround EX  
decoding  
12 configurable inputs  
3 independent zones  
BNC component video input and output  
connectors  
THX Ultra2 Certification  
RS-232 connector for flash memory  
software upgrades and configuration  
backups  
13 digital audio input connectors,  
including 6 S/PDIF coaxial, 6 S/PDIF  
optical, and 1 AES/EBU  
8 S-video input connectors  
5 composite video input connectors  
Broadcast-quality video switching  
Four 32-bit DSP engines  
2 digital audio output connectors  
3 trigger output connectors  
Rear panel IR input connector  
4 microphone input connectors  
2 internal expansion slots  
5.1-channel analog audio input connector  
Analog bypass option for stereo and  
5.1-channel  
connectors  
analog  
audio  
input  
Separate DSP engine for decoding  
compressed audio sources  
Auto switching between digital and  
analog audio input connectors  
Logic 7 decoding  
LIVE!  
(Lexicon  
Intelligent  
Variable  
Removable access panel  
24-bit/192kHz D/A converters for all Main  
Zone audio channels  
Environment)  
Balanced audio output connectors for all  
Main Zone and Zone 2 channels (MC-12  
Balanced only)  
Dolby Digital Surround EX, Dolby Pro  
Logic, Dolby Pro Logic II, and Dolby Pro  
Logic IIx decoding  
Stereo subwoofer and LFE output  
connectors  
EQ option available  
Automatic and manual calibration of  
speaker distances and output levels  
DTS 96/24, DTS NEO:6, and DTS-ES  
(discrete and matrix) decoding  
1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Getting Started  
PRODUCT REGISTRATION  
Please register the MC-12 Digital Controller within 15 days of  
purchase. Register online at www.lexicon.com or complete and  
return the product registration card attached to the back cover of  
this user guide. Retain the sales receipt as proof of warranty  
coverage.  
DO NOT place the MC-12 on a windowsill or any location exposed  
to direct sunlight.  
DO NOT obstruct the front-panel IR receiver window. The remote  
control must be in line of sight with the IR receiver for proper  
operation.  
DO NOT install the MC-12 on a surface that is unstable or unable  
to support all four feet, unless it is installed in an equipment rack.  
INSTALLATION CONSIDERATIONS  
The MC-12 requires special care during installation to ensure  
optimal performance. Pay particular attention to instructions below  
and to other precautions that appear throughout this user guide.  
DO NOT stack the MC-12 directly above heat-producing  
equipment such as a power amplifier.  
DO install the MC-12 on a solid, flat, level surface such as a table or  
shelf. The MC-12 can also be installed in a standard 19-inch  
equipment rack using an optional rack-mount kit available from an  
authorized Lexicon dealer.  
CAUTION!  
Before moving the MC-12, power the unit off using the  
rear-panel power switch and unplug the power cord from  
the wall outlet.  
DO select a dry, well-ventilated location out of direct sunlight.  
DO NOT expose the MC-12 to high temperatures, humidity,  
steam, smoke, dampness or excessive dust. Avoid installing the  
MC-12 near radiators and other heat-producing appliances.  
DO NOT install the MC-12 near unshielded TV or FM antennas,  
cable TV decoders, or other RF-emitting devices that might cause  
interference.  
DO NOT place the MC-12 on a thick rug or carpet, or cover the  
MC-12 with a cloth, as this might prevent proper cooling.  
1-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Getting Started  
Lexicon  
REMOTE CONTROL BATTERY INSTALLATION  
The remote control requires two AA batteries. The batteries should be replaced as needed. Alkaline batteries, which last longer without leaking,  
are recommended. When battery power is low, the remote control enters a low-voltage condition, preventing it from operating the MC-12.  
When this occurs, replace the batteries. Normal operation will resume when new batteries are installed.  
To replace the remote control batteries:  
1. Locate the battery compartment on the back of the remote control. Press the tab and lift the cover away from the remote control.  
2. Remove old batteries (if applicable).  
3. Observing the proper polarity, insert two AA batteries.  
4. Align the cover over the battery compartment and gently press down until it snaps back into place.  
5. Dispose of the old batteries (if applicable).  
1-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
Basic Operation  
Front-Panel Overview ................................................................ 2-2  
Rear-Panel Overview .................................................................. 2-6  
Remote Control Overview ....................................................... 2-10  
Operation Considerations ....................................................................... 2-10  
Main Menu ............................................................................................ 2-11  
Menu Navigation ................................................................................... 2-11  
Menu Item Selection .............................................................................. 2-11  
Command Bank Activation ..................................................................... 2-13  
Command Matrix .................................................................................. 2-14  
About the Zones ..................................................................... 2-19  
Two-line Status ........................................................................ 2-19  
Status Menus .......................................................................... 2-20  
Status Menu Descriptions ....................................................................... 2-21  
Status Menu Parameter Descriptions ...................................................... 2-25  
Status Menu Level Meters ........................................................ 2-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
FRONT-PANEL OVERVIEW  
The MC-12 is shown below. The MC-12 Balanced is shown on page 2-4. The front panels are identical, but the MC-12 Balanced has a larger chassis.  
11  
2
3
4
6
7
9
1
10  
12  
5
8
1. Standby Button  
2. Front Panel Display  
3. IR Receiver  
7. Main Zone Input Selection Buttons  
8. Main Zone Off Button  
9. Zone 2 Input Selection Buttons  
10. Zone 2 Off Button  
4. Volume Knob  
5. Mute Button  
11. Record Zone Input Selection Buttons  
12. Record Zone Off Button  
6. Mode and Buttons  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
1 STANDBY BUTTON  
4 VOLUME KNOB  
Use the Standby button to activate or deactivate standby mode.  
The Standby button performs no function when the MC-12 rear  
panel power switch is powered off. When standby mode is  
activated, all MC-12 zones that were active during the last session  
are reactivated. The red LED in the standby button lights to indicate  
that standby mode is activated. Power is still supplied to the MC-12  
when it is put into standby mode.  
Use the Volume knob to adjust volume level in all zones.  
Note:  
When MC-12 output levels are properly calibrated, the +0dB volume level  
setting corresponds to the THX reference level (75dB).  
To adjust the Main Zone volume level:  
Rotate the volume knob clockwise or counter-  
clockwise to increase or decrease the volume  
level in 1dB increments. A horizontal bar  
VOLUME  
-34db  
2 FRONT-PANEL DISPLAY  
graph indicating the current Main Zone volume level appears in the  
on-screen and front-panel displays. The Main Zone volume range is  
–80 to +12dB.  
Use the Front-Panel display to view the current input, listening  
mode, input source, and volume level. The 2 x 20 character display  
also functions as a display for messages and menus.  
To adjust the Zone 2 or Record Zone volume level:  
1. Press and hold the front panel Zone 2 or Record Zone input  
selection button that corresponds with the current input  
source. For example, if the current input source is DVD1, press  
and hold the DVD1 input selection button.  
3 IR RECEIVER  
The IR Receiver receives infrared commands from the MC-12  
remote control. There are three associated LEDs.  
2. Push and hold a Zone 2 or Record Zone  
ZONE 2 VOLUME -34db  
The amber LED blinks when a remote control command is  
received.  
input selection button while rotating the  
volume knob clockwise or counter-  
clockwise to increase or decrease volume  
level in 1dB increments. A horizontal bar  
graph appears on the on-screen and front  
panel displays. The Zone 2 or Record Zone volume range is –80  
to +12dB.  
The red LED lights when the A/D converters are overloading.  
RECORD VOLUME -34db  
The blue LED lights when the MC-12 is powered on and  
activated – even if the FRONT PANEL DISPLAY menu STATUS  
parameter is set to ALWAYS OFF.  
3. When the Zone 2 or Record Zone volume level has been set,  
release the input selection button.  
Red LED  
Blue LED  
Amber LED  
Remote control input selection buttons cannot be used to select  
Zone 2 or Record Zone volume level adjustment, even if the Zone 2  
or Record Zone command bank is activated.  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
FRONT-PANEL OVERVIEW (continued)  
The MC-12 Balanced, shown below, has a larger chassis than the MC-12, shown on page 2-2. Otherwise, they are identical.  
11  
2
3
4
6
7
9
1
10  
12  
5
8
5 MUTE BUTTON  
Press the Mute button to mute the MC-12 Main Zone volume;  
"MUTE ON" appears in the on-screen and front-panel displays. Press  
the Mute button again to restore the MC-12 volume to its original  
level. The VOLUME CONTROL SETUP and MUTE LEVEL parameter  
can be used to set mute levels.  
2-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
Mute can be activated automatically or manually. For example, the  
MC-12 briefly activates mute when changing input sources or  
listening modes. The amber LED in the Mute button lights  
whenever mute is activated.  
Zones remain deactivated until a Main or Record Zone input is  
selected.  
10 ZONE 2 OFF BUTTON  
Deactivates Zone 2.  
6 MODE AND BUTTONS  
Use the Mode buttons to scroll to the previous and next available  
listening mode. Scrolling occurs in the order shown in the MODE  
ADJUST menu. Press the Mode button to scroll upward through  
available listening modes. Press the Mode button to scroll  
downward through available listening modes.  
11 RECORD ZONE INPUT SELECTION BUTTONS  
Selects the input in the Record Zone. When an input is selected, a  
red LED lights on the corresponding input selection button. When  
the Record Zone is deactivated, pressing a Record Zone input  
selection button activates the Record Zone and selects the corre-  
sponding input. The Main Zone and Zone 2 remain deactivated  
until a Main Zone or Zone 2 input is selected.  
7 MAIN ZONE INPUT SELECTION BUTTONS  
Selects the input in the Main Zone. When an input is selected, a  
blue LED lights on the corresponding input selection button. When  
the Main Zone is deactivated, pressing a Main Zone input selection  
button activates the Main Zone and selects the corresponding  
input. Zone 2 and the Record Zone remain deactivated until a Zone  
2 or Record Zone input is selected.  
12 RECORD ZONE OFF BUTTON  
Deactivates the Record Zone.  
8 MAIN ZONE OFF BUTTON  
Deactivates the Main Zone.  
9 ZONE 2 INPUT SELECTION BUTTONS  
Selects the input in Zone 2. When an input is selected, an amber  
LED lights on the corresponding input selection button. When Zone  
2 is deactivated, pressing a Zone 2 input selection button activates  
Zone 2 and selects the corresponding input. The Main and Record  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
REAR-PANEL OVERVIEW  
The MC-12 is shown below. The MC-12 Balanced, shown on page 2-8, includes balanced audio connectors for the Main Zone and Zone 2.  
Otherwise both models are identical. The numbers in the rear-panel illustrations correspond with the numbered items.  
9
6
1
14  
10  
16  
9
11  
INPUTS  
SERIAL NO.  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
MC-12  
DESIGNED AND  
MAIN OUTPUTS  
INPUT 1  
INPUT 2  
INPUT 4  
INPUT 3  
OUTPUT  
RECORD OUTPUTS  
1
2
3
4
5
LEXICON, INC.  
Y
PR  
PB  
Y
PR  
PB  
Y
PR  
PB  
Y
ASSEMBLED IN U.S.A.  
1 (OSD)  
2
1
2
PR  
PB  
Y
PR  
PB  
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
L
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
FRONT  
CENTER  
SUBWOOFER  
SIDE  
REAR  
AUX  
Fix  
Fix  
Var  
Var  
ZONE 2  
L
CAUTION  
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  
DO NOT OPEN  
(L)  
(R)  
(C)  
(LS)  
(RS)  
L
L
L
L
L
ATTENTION  
RISQUE DE CHOC  
ELECTRIQUE  
(SUB)  
NE PAS OUVRIR  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
AC 100-240V~, 50-60 Hz, 90W  
LFE  
MICROPHONE INPUTS  
AUDIO  
AUDIO  
1
2
5
3
1
2
3
4
1
4
2
3
6
S/PDIF  
RS 232  
TRIGGER OUTPUTS  
1
2
IR IN  
4
6
5
LISTED  
AUDIO  
EQUIPMENT  
OMJ  
C
US  
24PB  
E216356  
+
+
+
PWR  
1
2
4
3
5
2
13  
12  
15  
7
1. Power Switch  
2. AC Input Adaptor  
9. Video Input Connectors  
10. Main Video Output Connectors  
3. Digital Audio Input Connectors  
4. Analog Audio Input Connectors  
11. Record Zone Video Output Connectors  
12. RS-232 Connectors  
5. Main Zone Audio Output Connectors  
6. Zone 2 Audio Output Connectors  
7. Record Zone Audio Output Connectors  
13. Trigger Output Connectors  
14. IR In Connector  
15. Microphone Input Connectors  
16. Removable Access Panel  
8. Balanced Audio Output Connectors (MC-12 Balanced)  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
When a 5.1-channel analog audio source is present in the Main Zone,  
input signals are sent to the Main Zone audio output connectors as  
indicated in the table below. When a 5.1-channel analog source is  
present in the Main Zone and the INPUT SETUP menu ZONE2 IN or  
RECORD IN parameter is set to DMIX, only the (L) and (R) input  
signals are sent to the Zone 2 or Record Zone audio output  
connectors.  
Caution!  
Never make or break connections to the MC-12 unless the  
MC-12 and all associated components are powered off.  
1 POWER SWITCH  
Use the Power switch to power the MC-12 on or off. The I and O  
positions represent "on" and "off" status respectively. When the  
MC-12 is powered on, the front-panel Standby button or remote  
control On button can be used to activate and deactivate standby  
mode. When the MC-12 is powered off, standby mode is not  
available.  
Input Connector  
(L) & (R)  
(C)  
Output Connector  
Front L/ R  
Center  
(SUB)  
Subwoofer L/R & LFE  
Side L/R and Rear L/R  
(LS) & (RS)  
2 AC INPUT CONNECTOR  
Provides power to the MC-12 through the supplied power cord  
(3 wire, 10 amp, IEC 320).  
5 MAIN ZONE AUDIO OUTPUT CONNECTORS  
Provide analog audio output in the Main Zone. Ten connectors labeled  
Front L/R, Center, LFE, Subwoofer L/R, Side L/R, and Rear L/R are  
available. Two connectors labeled Aux L/R are provided for future  
expansion.  
3 DIGITAL AUDIO INPUT CONNECTORS  
(S/PDIF & AES/EBU)  
Provide digital audio input in all zones. Six S/PDIF coaxial, six  
S/PDIF optical (5 TosLink /1 OMJ), and one AES/EBU (XLR) input  
connectors are available. These connectors are compatible with  
PCM (44.1, 48, 88.2, and 96kHz), Dolby Digital, and DTS-ES  
sources. These connectors are not compatible with MPEG or MP3  
sources.  
6 ZONE 2 AUDIO OUTPUT CONNECTORS  
Provide analog audio output in Zone 2. Two stereo connectors labeled  
Audio L/R are available. The connector labeled Fix passes audio at fixed  
output levels. The connector labeled Var passes audio at variable output  
levels and includes a built-in volume control.  
4 ANALOG AUDIO INPUT CONNECTORS  
Provide analog audio input. Eight stereo analog audio input  
connectors labeled 1 to 8 are available. Connectors labeled 6, 7 and  
8 can be configured as 5.1-channel connectors.  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
REAR-PANEL OVERVIEW (continued)  
The MC-12 is shown on page 2-4. The MC-12 Balanced, shown below, includes balanced audio connectors for the Main Zone and Zone 2. Otherwise  
both models are identical.  
9
6
1
14  
10  
16  
9
11  
INPUTS 4  
SERIAL NO.  
MC-12  
DESIGNED AND  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
RECORD OUTPUTS  
MAIN OUTPUTS  
INPUT 1  
INPUT 2  
INPUT 4  
INPUT 3  
OUTPUT  
1
2
3
5
LEXICON, INC.  
Y
PR  
PB  
Y
PR  
PB  
Y
PR  
PB  
Y
ASSEMBLED IN U.S.A.  
1 (OSD)  
2
1
2
PR  
PB  
Y
PR  
PB  
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
L
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Var  
FRONT  
CENTER  
SUBWOOFER  
SIDE  
REAR  
AUX  
Fix  
Fix  
Var  
ZONE 2  
L
CAUTION  
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  
DO NOT OPEN  
(L)  
(R)  
(C)  
(LS)  
(RS)  
L
L
L
L
L
ATTENTION  
RISQUE DE CHOC  
ELECTRIQUE  
(SUB)  
NE PAS OUVRIR  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
AC 100-240V~, 50-60 Hz, 90W  
LFE  
MICROPHONE INPUTS  
AUDIO  
AUDIO  
MAIN AUDIO OUTPUTS  
4
1
2
5
3
1
2
3
1
1
2
2
3
3
S/PDIF  
RS 232  
TRIGGER OUTPUTS  
1
2
IR IN  
4
6
4
5
5
6
6
LISTED  
AUDIO  
EQUIPMENT  
OMJ  
C
US  
+
+
+
24PB  
E216356  
PWR  
1
2
L
FRONT  
R
CENTER  
LFE  
L
SUBWOOFER  
R
L
SDE  
R
L
REAR  
R
L
AUX  
R
L
ZONE 2  
R
4
3
8
5
8
2
13  
12  
15  
7
Caution!  
Never make or break connections to the MC-12 unless the MC-12 and all associated components are powered off.  
2-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
7 RECORD ZONE AUDIO OUTPUT CONNECTORS  
10 MAIN VIDEO OUTPUT CONNECTORS  
Provide analog and digital audio output in the Record Zone. Two  
stereo connectors labeled Audio L/R are available for analog audio  
output. The connector labeled Fix passes audio at fixed output  
levels. The connector labeled Var passes audio at variable output  
levels and includes a built-in volume control. Two S/PDIF  
connectors (one coaxial and one optical) are available for digital  
audio output.  
Provide video output in the Main Zone. Two composite video  
connectors, two S-video connectors, and one component video  
connector (BNC) are available. The composite and S-video  
connectors labeled 1 (OSD) incorporate the on-screen display.  
Note:  
• Composite video output connectors are available when a composite or S-  
video source is present.  
Alternatively, these connectors can be used to connect a recording  
device. When the Record Zone audio output connector labeled Var  
is sent to a recording device, you should set the VOLUME  
CONTROL SETUP menu REC PWR ON parameter to +0dB to  
achieve appropriate recording levels. The Record Zone audio  
output connector labeled Var passes audio at variable output levels.  
Adjusting Record Zone volume level will affect the recording.  
• S-video output connectors are available when an S-video source is  
present.  
• Component video output connectors are available when a component  
video source is present.  
11 RECORD ZONE VIDEO OUTPUT CONNECTORS  
Provide video output in the Record Zone. Two composite video  
connectors and two S-video connectors are available. Alternatively,  
these connectors can be used to connect a video recording device.  
8 BALANCED AUDIO OUTPUT CONNECTORS  
(MC-12 BALANCED)  
Provide balanced analog audio output in the Main Zone and Zone  
2. Ten connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, Subwoofer L/R,  
Side L/R, and Rear L/R are available in the Main Zone. The  
connectors labeled Aux L/R are provided for future expansion. Two  
connectors labeled Zone 2 L/R are available in Zone 2.  
12 RS-232 CONNECTORS  
The RS-232 serial connector (1) is used to perform backup and  
restoration of configuration files and flash memory software  
upgrades. The RS-232 connector (2) is capable of supporting  
future developments.  
9 VIDEO INPUT CONNECTORS  
Provide video input in the Main and Record Zones. Five composite  
video connectors labeled Video 1 to 5, eight S-video connectors  
labeled S-Video 1 to 8, and four component video connectors  
(three RCA and one BNC) labeled INPUT 1 to 4 are available. The  
component video connectors are not available for the Record Zone.  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
REAR-PANEL OVERVIEW (continued)  
13 TRIGGER OUTPUT CONNECTORS  
REMOTE CONTROL OVERVIEW  
Provide 12V DC output to control connected components. Three  
trigger output connectors are available on a removable terminal block.  
The PWR connector – the power trigger output connector – is not  
configurable. It is activated when the MC-12 is activated, and deacti-  
vated when the MC-12 is deactivated. The trigger output connectors  
(1) and (2) can be configured for remote or program operation.  
The MC-12 remote control provides full operation of the MC-12,  
including commands such as menu navigation that are not available  
from the front-panel. The command matrix, beginning on page 2-14,  
indicates the commands remote control buttons perform when each  
command bank is active. The numbered items in the matrix corre-  
spond with the remote control illustrations.  
14 IR IN CONNECTOR  
OPERATION CONSIDERATIONS  
Accepts input of IR signals from infrared distribution equipment.  
One 3.5mm jack that accepts a stereo plug (Tip/Ring/Sleeve  
connection) or mono plug (Tip/Sleeve connection) is available.  
The following factors can improve or impede remote control  
operation.  
Note the following before operating the MC-12 remote control:  
15 MICROPHONE INPUT CONNECTORS  
The remote control must be in line-of-sight with the front-  
panel IR receiver. Eliminate obstructions between the remote  
control and the IR receiver. The remote control may become  
unreliable if strong sunlight or fluorescent light shines on the IR  
receiver.  
Provide microphone input for speaker distance and output level  
calibration. Additionally, inputs 1 (left) and 2 (right) are used when  
LIVE! is active. Four 3.5mm Tip/Ring/Sleeve connectors are  
available.  
For optimal performance, position the remote control at a 30  
degree angle no more than 17 feet (5m) from the MC-12.  
Placing the MC-12 inside a smoked glass cabinet will reduce  
the remote control range.  
16 REMOVABLE ACCESS PANEL  
Accommodates connectors for emerging technologies.  
Remote controls for different components can interfere with  
one another. Avoid using remote controls for different compo-  
nents at the same time.  
Remote control batteries should be replaced as needed.  
2-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
MAIN MENU  
MENU NAVIGATION  
The MAIN MENU represents the beginning of  
the menu structure. Use the MAIN MENU to  
open the three main menu branches: MODE  
ADJUST, AUDIO CONTROLS, and SETUP.  
Use the remote control Menu and arrow buttons to navigate the  
extensive menu structure shown in the Appendix. The table below  
indicates the navigation commands remote control buttons  
perform when the Main Zone command bank is activated.  
MAIN MENU  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
Button  
Navigation Function(s)  
• When no menus are displayed, press the MENU button to open the MAIN MENU.  
• When a menu is open, press the MENU button to close the menu structure.  
• When no menus are displayed, press the arrow button to open the MAIN MENU.  
• When a menu is open, press the arrow button to select the highlighted menu item.  
• When a menu is open, press the arrow button to close the menu and, in most cases, open the previous menu. Sub-  
sequent presses continue to close the current menu and open the previous menu until the MAIN MENU is closed.  
When the MAIN MENU is closed, the menu structure is also closed.  
• When no menus are displayed, pressing the arrow button performs no function.  
• When a drop-down menu is open, press the arrow button to select the current setting and close the drop-down  
menu.  
When a menu is open, press the or arrow buttons to scroll upward or downward through the complete list of menu  
items. All menu items are displayed on-screen. A scroll bar appears on the right side of the menu when menu items exceed  
the top and bottom margins of the display, and the cursor automatically advances to the next menu item when the first or  
last menu item is passed. The highlighted menu item is displayed on the MC-12 front-panel.  
2. When the desired menu item is highlighted, press the arrow  
MENU ITEM SELECTION  
button to select the highlighted item. If you select an option,  
another menu displays. If you select a parameter, a parameter  
menu or horizontal graph opens.  
Use the remote control Menu arrows to select menu items.  
To select a menu item:  
1. Press the remote control or arrow buttons to highlight the  
desired menu item.  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
displayed beneath the parameter name in the on-screen and  
front-panel displays.  
MENU OPTIONS  
Selecting a menu option opens another menu within the menu  
structure. For example, selecting SETUP from the MAIN MENU opens  
the SETUP menu.  
2. When the desired setting appears beneath the parameter  
name, press the arrow button to accept the setting and  
close the drop-down menu.  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
HORIZONTAL BAR GRAPHS  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGER  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
Selecting some menu parameters opens a horizontal bar graph. The  
bar graph indicates the position the current parameter setting falls  
within the entire parameter range. The setting appears to the right of  
the parameter name in the on-screen and front-panel displays.  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
For example, selecting the DISPLAY SETUP menu A/V SYNC DELAY  
parameter opens the horizontal bar graph shown below, which is  
used to adjust the amount of audio delay.  
MENU PARAMETERS  
Selecting a menu parameter opens a drop-down menu or  
horizontal bar graph that is used to select the desired setting.  
OFF, 1 to 60ms  
DISPLAY SETUP  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
PARAMETER DROP-DOWN MENUS  
OFF  
OFF  
Selecting a menu parameter opens a drop-down menu that  
contains a list of available parameter settings. For example,  
selecting the DISPLAY SETUP menu CUSTOM NAME parameter  
opens a drop-down menu which is used to select the ON or OFF  
setting.  
To adjust a parameter setting with a horizontal bar graph:  
1. When the horizontal bar graph appears, press the remote control  
or arrow button to increase or decrease the setting in  
designated increments.  
ON  
OFF  
DISPLAY SETUP  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
OFF  
OFF  
The setting appears to the right of the parameter name in the  
on-screen and front-panel displays.  
2. When you have finished adjusting the settings, press the arrow  
To select a setting in a parameter drop-down menu:  
button to select the setting and close the horizontal bar graph.  
1. When the drop-down menu opens, press the remote control  
or arrow button to scroll up or down through the  
complete list of available settings. The current setting is  
2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
COMMAND BANK ACTIVATION  
Remote control buttons perform different commands depending on  
whether the Main Zone, Zone 2, Record Zone, or Shift command  
bank is activated. Pressing and releasing a remote control command  
bank selection button – MAIN, ZONE, REC, or SHIFT – activates the  
corresponding command bank. The selected command bank  
remains activated until another command bank is activated.  
The MAIN MENUSETUPDISPLAYSON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
menu REMOTE STATE parameter controls the remote control  
command bank indicator that appears on the on-screen display.  
When the REMOTE STATE parameter is set to ON, a command bank  
indicator appears in the top-right corner of the on-screen display to  
indicate the last command bank from which the MC-12 received a  
command. A "Z" appears when the Zone 2 command bank is  
active. An "R" appears when Record Zone command bank is active.  
An "S" appears when the Shift command bank is active. No letter  
appears when the Main Zone command bank is active. When the  
REMOTE STATE parameter is set to OFF, no command bank  
indicator appears on the on-screen display.  
The command bank selection buttons themselves do not send  
commands to the MC-12. When pressed and released, these  
buttons activate the corresponding command bank. For example,  
pressing and releasing the SHIFT button activates the Shift  
command bank. When the Shift command bank is activated,  
pressing and releasing the DVD-1 button turns off the DVD1 input  
for the Main Zone.  
Note:  
To activate a command bank:  
Remote control command bank selection buttons should not be pressed  
and held.  
1. Press and release a command bank selection button to activate  
the desired command bank.  
The command matrix that begins on the next page indicates  
the commands remote control buttons perform when each  
command bank is activated.  
2. Press a remote control button to send a command to the MC-12.  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
COMMAND MATRIX  
1
2
3
The command matrix describes the commands remote control buttons perform when each  
command bank is active.  
Button  
Main Zone  
Zone 2  
Record Zone  
Shift  
Activates and deactivates standby mode when the MC-12 rear panel power switch is in the on position.  
When standby mode is activated, pressing the standby button deactivates standby mode and activates  
the MC-12, including all zones that were activated during the previous operating session. When standby  
mode is deactivated, pressing the standby button activates standby mode and deactivates the MC-12.  
The red front panel standby button LED lights to indicate that standby mode is activated.  
1
4
Note: Power is still supplied to the MC-12 when standby mode is activated.  
Activates the remote control back-light, illuminating remote control buttons making them more visible in  
the dark. The back-light also illuminates whenever a remote control button is pressed. Once illuminated,  
the back-light remains on for about 5 seconds before extinguishing.  
2
3
Activates the Main Zone command bank, which includes commands that control the Main Zone.  
Activates the Zone 2 command bank, which includes commands that control the Zone 2.  
Activates the Record Zone command bank, which includes commands that control the Record and  
Main Zones.  
Activates the Shift command bank, which includes commands that control the Main Zone.  
Selects the DVD1 input Selects the DVD1 input Selects the DVD1 input Deactivates the Main  
4
for the Main Zone.  
for Zone 2.  
for the Record Zone.  
Zone.  
Selects the DVD2 input Selects the DVD2 input Selects the DVD2 input Deactivates Zone 2.  
for the Main Zone. for Zone 2. for the Record Zone.  
Selects the LD input for Selects the LD input for Selects the LD input for Deactivates the  
the Main Zone. Zone 2. the Record Zone. Record Zone.  
Selects the TV input for Selects the TV input for Selects the TV input for Sets the AUDIO  
the Main Zone.  
Zone 2.  
the Record Zone.  
CONTROLS menu  
LOUDNESS parameter  
to ON.  
2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
Button  
Main Zone  
Zone 2  
Record Zone  
Shift  
Selects the SAT input for Selects the SAT input for Selects the SAT input for Sets the AUDIO  
4
the Main Zone.  
Zone 2.  
the Record Zone.  
CONTROLS menu  
LOUDNESS parameter  
to OFF.  
Selects the VCR input for Selects the VCR input for Selects the VCR input  
the Main Zone. Zone 2. for the Record Zone.  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
4
Selects the CD input for Selects the CD input for Selects the CD input for Increases the AUDIO  
the Main Zone.  
for Zone 2.  
the Record Zone.  
CONTROLS menu BASS  
parameter in 0.5dB  
increments.  
Selects the PVR input for Selects the PVR input for Selects the PVR input for Increases the AUDIO  
the Main Zone.  
Zone 2.  
the Record Zone.  
CONTROLS menu  
TREBLE parameter in  
0.5dB increments.  
Selects the GAME input Selects the GAME input Selects the GAME input Increases the AUDIO  
for the Main Zone.  
for Zone 2.  
for the Record Zone.  
CONTROLS menu TILT  
EQ parameter in 0.2dB  
increments.  
Selects the TAPE input Selects the TAPE input  
for the Main Zone. for Zone2.  
Selects the TAPE input Decreases the AUDIO  
for the Record Zone.  
CONTROLS menu BASS  
parameter in 0.5dB  
increments.  
Selects the TUNER input Selects the TUNER input Selects the TUNER input Decreases the AUDIO  
for the Main Zone.  
for Zone 2.  
for the Record Zone.  
CONTROLS menu  
TREBLE parameter in  
0.5dB increments.  
Selects the AUX input  
for the Main Zone.  
Selects the AUX input  
for Zone 2.  
Selects the AUX input  
for the Record Zone.  
Decreases the AUDIO  
CONTROLS menu TILT  
EQ parameter in 0.2dB  
increments.  
2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
Button  
Main Zone  
Zone 2  
Record Zone  
Shift  
Toggles the FRONT  
PANEL DISPLAY menu  
STATUS parameter  
Sets Zone 2 volume  
level to -15dB  
Sets Record Zone  
volume level to -15dB  
Sets Main Zone volume  
level to -15dB.  
5
between ALWAYS OFF  
and the current setting.  
Toggles the ON SCREEN Sets Zone 2 volume  
Sets Record Zone  
volume level to -30dB  
Sets Main Zone volume  
level to -30dB.  
6
7
DISPLAY menu BACK-  
GROUND parameter  
between ON and OFF.  
level to -30dB  
5
8
6
9
Toggles the ON  
Reserved for possible  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
Sets the AUDIO  
CONTROL menu BASS,  
TREBLE, and TILT EQ  
parameters to +0.0dB.  
However, the screen  
displays:  
SCREEN DISPLAY menu future expansion.  
STATUS parameter  
between ALWAYS OFF  
and the current setting.  
7
EQ BALANCE  
EQ OFF  
10  
Scroll to the previous or Activates (+) and  
Activates (+) and  
deactivates (-) the  
trigger output  
connector labeled 2  
when the connector is  
configured for remote  
operation.  
Activates (+) and  
8
next available listening  
deactivates (-) the  
deactivates (-) standby  
mode when the MC-12  
is powered on with the  
rear panel power switch.  
mode, with the current trigger output  
Main Zone input source. connector labeled 1  
Scrolling occurs in the  
order shown on the  
MODE ADJUST menu.  
when the connector is  
configured for remote  
operation.  
Increases and decreases Increases and decreases Increases and decreases Increases and decreases  
Main Zone volume level Zone 2 volume level in Record Zone volume Main Zone volume level  
level in 1dB increments. in 1dB increments.  
9
in 1dB increments.  
1dB increments.  
Toggles between  
lowering Main Zone  
volume level and  
restoring Main Zone  
volume to the original  
level.  
Toggles between full  
Zone 2 muting and  
unmuting Zone 2  
volume to the original Zone volume to the  
level. original level.  
Toggles between full  
Record Zone muting  
and unmuting Record  
Toggles between full  
Main Zone muting and  
unmuting Main Zone  
volume to the original  
level.  
10  
2-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
Button  
Main Zone  
Zone 1  
Record Zone  
Shift  
Displays the Main Zone Displays the Zone 2  
Displays the Record Opens and closes the  
11  
status menu for the  
two-line status for 2  
seconds.  
two-line status for 2  
seconds.  
Zone two-line status  
current input source.  
for 2 seconds.  
When a menu is open, Centers the AUDIO  
Centers the AUDIO  
CONTROLS menu  
RECORD BALANCE  
parameter.  
Centers the AUDIO  
CONTROLS menu  
Main Zone BALANCE  
and FADER parameters.  
12  
13  
pressing the MENU  
button closes the  
structure. When no  
menus are open,  
pressing the MENU  
button opens the MAIN  
MENU.  
CONTROLS menu  
ZONE2 BALANCE  
parameter.  
11  
12  
Adjusts the AUDIO  
CONTROLS menu  
ZONE2 BALANCE  
parameter left and  
right.  
Adjusts the AUDIO  
CONTROLS menu  
RECORD BALANCE  
parameter left and  
right.  
Adjusts the AUDIO  
CONTROLS menu  
Main Zone BALANCE  
parameters left and right.  
Closes the current ()  
menu or opens the  
menu structure and  
selects the highlighted  
menu item ().  
13  
14  
13  
15  
Scroll upward and  
downward through  
menu items.  
Increase and decrease  
subwoofer output levels future expansion.  
applied to the current  
Reserved for possible Adjusts the AUDIO  
CONTROLS menu  
Main Zone FADER  
listening mode.  
parameters forward ()  
and backward ().  
Toggles between 7- and Reserved for possible  
Reserved for possible Adjusts the MAIN ADV  
14  
15  
5-channel playback.  
future expansion.  
future expansion.  
menu INPUT SELECT  
parameter, cycling  
through the ANALOG,  
DIGITAL, and AUTO  
settings.  
NOTE:  
Use of this button during  
LIVE! voids the LIVE!  
calibration.  
Toggles between the  
Reserved for possible  
Reserved for possible Toggles the MAIN ADV  
current listening mode future expansion.  
and the 2-CHANNEL  
listening mode.  
future expansion.  
menu ANALOG BYPASS  
parameter between ON  
and OFF.  
2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
Button  
Main Zone  
Zone 1  
Record Zone  
Shift  
Selects the THX mode  
family for the current  
input source.  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
Activates the 5.1 THX  
ULTRA2, 5.1 THX SurEX,  
or 5.1 THX listening  
mode when a  
16  
5.1-channel Dolby  
Digital source is present.  
Selects the Dolby mode Reserved for possible  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
Activates the Dolby  
Digital EX or Dolby  
Digital listening mode  
family for the current  
input source.  
future expansion.  
when a 5.1-channel  
Dolby Digital source is  
present.  
Selects the LOGIC 7 FILM Reserved for possible  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
Activates the  
PANORAMA listening  
mode.  
mode family for the  
current input source.  
future expansion.  
Selects the LOGIC 7 TV Reserved for possible  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
Activates the MONO  
LOGIC listening mode  
for 2-channel sources  
and the 5.1 MONO  
mode family for the  
current input source.  
future expansion.  
LOGIC listening mode  
for 5.1 channel sources.  
16  
Selects the DTS mode  
family for the current  
input source.  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
When a DTS-ES source  
is present, pressing the  
dts button toggles the  
ES DECODING  
parameter, cycling  
through the AUTO,  
ON, and OFF settings.  
Selects the LOGIC 7  
MUSIC mode family for future expansion.  
Reserved for possible  
Reserved for possible  
future expansion.  
Activates the L7 MUSIC  
SURR listening mode.  
the current input  
source.  
2-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
ABOUT THE ZONES  
The MC-12 features three zones of operation: the Main Zone, Zone  
2, and the Record Zone. The Main Zone controls audio and video  
sources in the primary listening space. Zone 2 controls audio  
sources in the secondary listening space. The Record Zone controls  
audio and video sources sent to recording devices or to a third  
listening space.  
3. When the MAIN MENUSETUPINPUTSINPUT SETUP menu  
ZONE2 IN or RECORD IN parameter is set to ANLG, the Zone 2 or  
Record Zone audio output connectors are not available during  
5.1a BYPASS listening mode. However, it is possible to have a  
5.1-channel analog audio source present in the Main Zone and a  
digital audio source present in Zone 2 or the Record Zone.  
These zones have separate digital audio receivers and dedicated  
analog source selectors that allow for independent input selection  
in each zone. The MC-12 can process input sources in three zones  
at the same time. For example, the MC-12 can play a DVD in the  
Main Zone, while playing a CD in Zone 2, while sending satellite  
receiver signals to a VCR in the Record Zone.  
TWO-LINE STATUS  
The two-line status opens on the on-screen and front panel displays  
whenever the MC-12 detects a status change such as a new input  
source or listening mode. The information included on the two-line  
status differs depending on the zone in which the MC-12 last  
detected a status change. For example, the Main Zone two-line  
status opens when a Main Zone status change is detected.  
The following are exceptions to independent zone operation:  
1. When a Dolby Digital or DTS-ES source is present in the Main  
Zone, the same Dolby Digital or DTS-ES source can also be  
present in Zone 2 or the Record Zone. However, a different  
Dolby Digital or DTS-ES source cannot be present in Zone 2 or  
the Record Zone.  
MAIN ZONE TWO-LINE STATUS  
Opens on the on-screen and front panel  
displays whenever the MC-12 detects a Main  
Zone status change. The Main Zone two-line  
DVD1  
FILM  
D
VOL  
-34dB  
2. Main Zone multi-channel audio can be down-mixed in Zone 2 or  
the Record Zone when all of the following conditions are met:  
status indicates the current input, listening mode, input source, and  
volume level selected in the Main Zone.  
A Dolby Digital or DTS-ES source is present in the Main Zone.  
The Main Zone input is also selected in Zone 2 or the  
Record Zone. For example, if the DVD1 input is selected in  
the Main Zone, the DVD1 input must also be selected in  
Zone 2 or the Record Zone.  
ZONE 2 TWO-LINE STATUS  
Opens on the on-screen and front panel  
displays whenever the MC-12 detects a Zone  
2 status change. The Zone 2 two-line status  
DVD1  
ZONE 2  
D
VOL  
-34dB  
The MAIN MENUSETUPINPUTSINPUT SETUP menu  
ZONE2 IN or RECORD IN parameter is set to DMIX.  
indicates the current input, input source, and volume level selected  
in Zone 2.  
2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
To open and navigate the STATUS menu for the current input  
source:  
RECORD ZONE TWO-LINE STATUS  
Opens on the on-screen and front panel  
displays whenever the MC-12 detects a  
Record Zone status change. The Record Zone  
two-line status indicates the current input, input source, and  
volume level selected in the Record Zone.  
DVD1  
ZONE 2  
D
VOL  
-34dB  
1. Press and release the remote control SHIFT button.  
2. Press and release the remote control STAT button.  
The first page of the STATUS menu for the current input source  
appears in the on-screen and front-panel displays.  
The ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu STATUS parameter can control the  
length of time for which the two-line status appears on the  
on-screen and front panel displays. The ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu  
POSITION parameter can control the vertical alignment of the  
two-line status on the display device screen.  
If the STATUS menu includes a second page, the PG1 indicator  
appears in the top-right corner of the menu. Press and release  
the STAT button again to open the second page. If the STATUS  
menu does not include a second page, pressing and releasing  
the STAT button again closes the menu.  
3. When the desired STATUS menu page opens, press the remote  
control MAIN button, then press the or arrow button to  
scroll up or down through the list of available parameters.  
Note:  
When the display device is connected to a component video output con-  
nector and the ADVANCED menu COMPONENT OSD parameter is set to  
OFF, the display device does not show the on-screen display, including the  
two-line status.  
4. Press the STAT button to close the STATUS menu. In some  
cases, you must press STAT twice in succession to close the  
STATUS menu.  
Note:  
STATUS MENUS  
STATUS menu parameters provide information about the current  
input source and listening mode. These parameters cannot be  
adjusted.  
The STATUS menu contains parameters that provide information about  
the current input source and listening mode. STATUS menus are  
available for 2-channel, Dolby Digital, DTS-ES analog, digital, and LIVE!  
input sources.  
STATUS menu parameters provide information about the current  
input source and listening mode. Some STATUS menus also include  
level meters that indicate fluctuating audio input levels. Unlike most  
other menus, STATUS menus cannot be opened by selecting menu  
options. The remote control command sequence outlined below  
must be executed.  
2-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
STATUS MENU DESCRIPTIONS  
D STATUS  
The table beneath each description lists the default and possible  
settings for each parameter.  
Provides information about Dolby Digital input sources. Features L,  
C, R, SL, SR and SUB level meters.  
2CH STATUS  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
Provides information about 2-channel input sources. Features L and  
R level meters.  
INPUT  
The current input  
The current listening mode  
3/2.1, 3/2, 3/1, 2/2, 2/1, 2/0, 1/0  
32 to 640kbps  
MODE  
CHANNELS  
BIT RATE  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
INPUT  
The current input  
EX ENCODING  
SAMPLE RATE  
2.0 ENCODING  
DIALOG OFFSET  
MIX ROOM  
CENTER MIX LVL  
SURR MIX LVL  
MATRIX, NO  
MODE  
The current listening mode  
ANLG, PCM  
48kHz  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
MATRIX, NONE  
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz  
-27 to +4dB  
SMALL, LARGE  
-3.0dB, -4.5dB, -6.0dB  
+0.0dB, -3.0dB, -6.0dB  
2CH STATUS  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
D STATUS  
INPUT  
MODE  
CHANNELS  
BIT RATE  
PG1  
D STATUS  
PG2  
L
R
dB  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
SAMPLE RATE  
2.0 ENCODING  
DIALOG OFFSET  
MIX ROOM  
CENTER MIX LVL  
SURR MIX LVL  
-45  
EX ENCODING  
L
C
R
SL  
LFE  
dB  
SR  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
-45  
2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
STATUS  
5.1 ANALOG STATUS  
Provides information about DTS-ES input sources. Includes L, C, R,  
SL, SR, SB and LFE level meters.  
Provides information about 5.1-channel analog sources. Includes L,  
C, R, SL, and LFE level meters.  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
INPUT  
The current input  
INPUT  
The current input  
MODE  
The current listening mode  
3/3.1, 3/2.1  
MODE  
The current listening mode  
ANLG  
CHANNELS  
BIT RATE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
754.5 to 1509.7kbps  
DISCRETE, MATRIX, OFF  
16 bits, 20 bits, 24 bits  
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz  
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz  
ES ENCODING  
WORD LENGTH  
SAMPLE RATE  
Note:  
The only possible sample rate for 5.1 analog sources is 96kHz, as they  
are converted to 96kHz PCM at the MC-12 input (when MAIN  
ADVANCED ANALOG BYPASS is set to OFF).  
STATUS  
WORD LENGTH  
SAMPLE RATE  
STATUS  
INPUT  
MODE  
CHANNELS  
BIT RATE  
PG1  
PG1  
5.1 ANALOG STATUS  
STATUS  
PG1  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
WORD LENGTH  
SAMPLE RATE  
ENCODING  
dB  
L
C
R
SL  
LFE  
SR  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
dB  
L
C
R
SL  
LFE  
SR  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
-45  
-45  
2-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
5.1a BYPASS STATUS  
2CH BYPASS STATUS  
Provides information about 5.1-channel analog input sources when  
the MAIN ADV menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to ON.  
Provides information about 2-channel analog input sources when  
the MAIN ADV menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to ON.  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
INPUT  
The current input  
5.1a BYPASS  
BYPASS  
INPUT  
The current input  
2CH BYPASS  
BYPASS  
MODE  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
INPUT TYPE  
5.1a BYPASS STATUS  
2CH BYPASS STATUS  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
2-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
DIGITAL STATUS  
LIVE! STATUS  
Provides information about digital input sources for which a sample  
rate is detected, but no audio is present in the input signal.  
Provides information about LIVE! input sources.  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
INPUT  
The current input  
INPUT  
The current input  
MODE  
The current listening mode  
MODE  
The current listening mode  
---  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
MIC  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
48kHz  
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz  
2CH STATUS  
DIGITAL STATUS  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
L
R
dB  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
-45  
2-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
MC-12  
Basic Operation  
Possible settings for Dolby Digital input sources include 3/2.1, 3/2,  
3/1, 2/2, 2/1, 2/0 and 1/0. Current settings for DTS-ES input  
sources include 3/3.1 and 3/2.1.  
STATUS MENU PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS  
2.0 ENCODING  
MATRIX, NONE  
DIALOG OFFSET  
-27 to +4dB  
Indicates whether or not a matrix-encoded source is detected.  
When the parameter setting is MATRIX, a matrix-encoded source is  
detected. When the parameter setting is NONE, a matrix-encoded  
source is not detected. The MC-12 cannot automatically detect  
matrix encoding in non-flagged input sources.  
Indicates the dialog normalization value applied to the input signal.  
Dolby Digital input sources reproduce dialog at 27 decibels below  
full-scale (-27dBFS). When the dialog normalization value of the  
incoming signal is higher or lower, the DIALOG OFFSET parameter  
indicates the amount of adjustment the MC-12 makes to normalize  
dialog to -27dBFS.  
BIT RATE  
32 to 640 kbps or 754 to 1509.7kbps  
Indicates the rate at which the input signal is encoded. A higher bit rate  
indicates that less compression was used during the encoding process.  
Possible settings for Dolby Digital sources range from 32 to 640 kbps.  
Possible settings for DTS-ES sources range from 754 to 1509.7kbps.  
ES ENCODING  
DISCRETE, MATRIX, OFF  
Indicates whether or not a DTS-ES-encoded source is detected.  
When the parameter setting is DISCRETE, a discrete 6.1-channel  
DTS-ES source is detected. When the parameter setting is MATRIX,  
a 5.1-channel DTS-ES source with a surround-encoded back  
channel is detected. When the parameter setting is OFF, a standard  
DTS source with no DTS-ES encoding is detected.  
CENTER MIX LVL  
-3.0dB, -4.5dB, -6.0dB  
Indicates the relative level of the center channel that was used  
during the mixing process.  
EX ENCODING  
MATRIX, NONE  
CHANNELS  
3/3.1, 3/2.1, 3/2, 3/1, 2/2, 2/1, 2/0, 1/0  
Indicates whether or not a Dolby Digital Surround EX-encoded  
source is detected. When the parameter setting is MATRIX, a  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded with Dolby Digital  
Surround EX is detected. When the parameter setting is NONE, a  
standard 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded without Dolby  
Digital Surround EX-encoding is detected. The MC-12 cannot  
automatically detect Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding in  
non-flagged input sources.  
Indicates the number of channels present in the input source. The  
first digit indicates the number of front channels present. The digit  
after the slash indicates the number of surround channels present.  
The digit after the decimal point indicates the presence of LFE (low  
frequency effects) information. For example, if the CHANNELS  
parameter is set to 3/2.1 and LFE=ON, LFE information (the .1  
channel) is sent to the LFE output. If the CHANNELS parameter is  
set to 3/2.1 and LFE=OFF, LFE information is sent to the subwoofer  
output(s) and/or speakers, depending on crossover settings.  
2-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Basic Operation  
Lexicon  
INPUT  
STATUS MENU LEVEL METERS  
Indicates the selected input (for example, DVD1).  
Most STATUS menus contain level meters that indicate fluctuating  
input levels in the front left (L), center (C), front right (R), surround left  
(SL), surround right (SR), surround back (SB) and subwoofer (SUB)  
channels. These level meters indicate input levels for both analog and  
digital input sources. For example, the level meters indicate digital  
audio input levels when a digital audio source is present.  
INPUT TYPE  
ANLG, BYP, PCM, MIC, ---  
Indicates the input source that is present. When the parameter  
setting is ANLG, a 2-channel analog audio source is present and the  
ADVANCED menu 2-CH ANLG BYP parameter is set to OFF. When  
the parameter setting is BYP (Bypass), a 2-channel analog audio  
source is present and the 2-CH ANLG BYP parameter is set to ON.  
When the parameter setting is PCM, a 2-channel digital audio  
source is present. When the parameter setting is MIC, a micro-  
phone source is present. When the parameter setting is ---, an  
unknown digital audio source is present.  
Different combinations of level meters appear on each STATUS menu,  
depending on the source that is present. The SB level meter appears  
when a 6.1-channel source is present, or when a 5.1-channel source  
is present and the ES DECODING parameter is set to ON.  
Level meters appear in combinations of green, yellow and red when  
the on-screen display is configured for a blue-screen background.  
Green indicates low levels, yellow indicates normal levels, and red  
indicates high levels and the onset of overload. Level meters appear  
in white when the on-screen display is not configured for a blue  
screen background.  
MIX ROOM  
SMALL, LARGE  
Indicates the size of the mixing room that was used during the mixing  
process. When the parameter setting is LARGE, you should set the  
RE-EQUALIZATION parameter to ON for THX listening modes.  
MODE  
Indicates the activated listening mode (e.g., L7 FILM).  
SAMPLE RATE  
44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz  
Indicates the sample rate of the input source that is present.  
SURR MIX LVL  
+0.0dB, -3.0dB, -6.0dB  
Indicates the relative surround channel level that was used during  
the mixing process.  
WORD LENGTH  
16 bits, 20 bits, 24 bits  
Indicates the word length of the audio data present in the input signal.  
2-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
3
Setup  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setup  
Lexicon  
SETUP  
Selecting SETUP from the MAIN MENU opens the SETUP menu.  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
SETUP  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
Opens the REAR PANEL CONFIG menu, to configure the analog audio input  
connectors as eight stereo connectors or as five stereo and one 5.1-channel  
connectors. See “REAR PANEL CONFIG” on page 3-59 for more  
information.  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
DISPLAYS  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
Opens the DISPLAY SETUP menu, to customize the on-screen and  
front-panel displays, restore audio/video synchronization, and  
create and activate a custom unit name. See “DISPLAY SETUP” on  
page 3-61 for more information.  
INPUTS  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
Prompts for an input selection (e.g., DVD1), and opens the corre-  
sponding INPUT SETUP menu. When the menu is open, you can  
change input names, assign audio and video input connectors, select  
preferred listening modes, and configure Main Zone, Zone 2 and  
Record Zone settings. See “INPUT SETUP” on page 3-4 for more  
information.  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
Opens the VOLUME CONTROL SETUP menu, to configure Main Zone,  
Zone 2, and Record Zone volume levels. See “VOLUME CONTROL  
SETUP” on page 3-66 for more information.  
SPEAKERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
TRIGGERS  
Opens the SPEAKER SETUP menu, to configure the Main Zone  
audio output connectors for the desired speaker setup. See  
“SPEAKER SETUP” on page 3-22 for more information.  
SETUP  
TRIGGERS  
Prompts the selection of a desired trigger output connector (1 or 2)  
and opens the corresponding TRIGGER SETUP menu for configu-  
ration of remote or program operation. See “TRIGGER SETUP” on  
page 3-68 for more information.  
3-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
MC-12  
Setup  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SETUP  
LOCK OPTIONS  
SETUP  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
Opens the LOCK OPTIONS menu, to protect MODE ADJUST,  
AUDIO CONTROLS and SETUP menu branch settings from  
accidental changes. See “LOCK OPTIONS” on page 3-70 for more  
information.  
Opens the LIVE! CALIBRATION menu, to perform the necessary  
calibration before using the LIVE! modes. See “LIVE! Calibration” on  
page 3-71 for more information.  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
INPUT SETUP  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
(INPUT)  
INPUT SETUP  
Selecting the SETUP menu INPUTS option prompts the selection of a desired input (e.g., DVD1). Selecting an input opens the corresponding  
INPUT SETUP menu, which changes input names, assigns audio and video input connectors, selects preferred listening modes, and configures  
advanced Main Zone, Zone 2, and Record Zone settings.  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
VCR  
CD  
FILM  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
RECORD ADVANCED  
The DVD1 INPUT SETUP menu is shown here as an example, and will continue to be shown as an example throughout this section. Whenever it appears, any other INPUT SETUP  
menu can be substituted. Likewise, whenever the DVD1 input appears as a step in a menu path, any other input can be substituted.  
All INPUT SETUP menus are shown in the Appendix on page A-6. The parameters on the left side of the INPUT SETUP menus are identical  
regardless of which input is selected. The parameter settings on the right side are adjustable. The INPUT SETUP menus shown in the Appendix  
indicate factory-default parameter settings for each input.  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Setup  
CHANGING INPUT NAMES  
Selecting the INPUT SETUP menu NAME parameter opens the INPUT NAME menu, to customize or restore the factory-default name of the selected  
input. Factory-default input names correspond to front-panel and remote control input selection button labels.  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
SETUP  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 INPUT NAME  
EDIT INPUT NAME  
DVD1  
MAIN MENU  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
DVD1  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
EDIT INPUT NAME  
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
BUTTONS TO EDIT  
UP TO 8 CHARACTERS  
BUTTON TO ADVANCE  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
FILM  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
INPUT SETUP  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
RT-20  
(DVD1)  
DVD2  
MAIN ADVANCED  
LD  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
TV  
SAT  
RECORD ADVANCED  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
EDIT INPUT NAME  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
NAME  
EDIT INPUT NAME  
Opens the EDIT INPUT NAME editing menu, to customize the name  
of the selected input. Custom input names can include up to eight  
characters.  
2. When the editing menu opens, the current input name appears  
on the second line. Use the remote control and arrow  
buttons to change the character above the cursor (^).  
3. When the character you want is displayed, press the arrow  
button to advance to the next character space. The cursor will  
automatically wrap to the first character space when the last  
character space is passed.  
To customize the name of the selected input:  
1. Follow the EDIT INPUT NAME menu path to open the EDIT  
INPUT NAME editing menu.  
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Setup  
Lexicon  
CHANGING INPUT NAMES (continued)  
Note:  
The custom input name appears in the on-screen and front-panel  
displays. Both the custom and factory-default input names appear  
in the INPUT SETUP menu. The custom input name appears against  
the left margin of the on-screen display, and the factory-default  
input name appears in parentheses against the right margin.  
Pressing the arrow button closes the menu and returns to the INPUT  
NAME menu.  
4. Repeat step 3 to enter all characters in the new name. When the  
input name you want is displayed, press the arrow button to  
close the menu and return to the INPUT NAME menu.  
SETUP  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
MAIN MENU  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 INPUT NAME  
PRESS MENU  
RESTORE INPUT NAME  
V
TO  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
DVD1  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
EDIT INPUT NAME  
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME  
DVD2  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
LD  
TV  
AUTO  
SAT  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
FILM  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
RECORD ADVANCED  
To restore the factory-default name of the selected input:  
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME  
1. Follow the RESTORE DEFAULT NAME menu path to open the  
INPUT NAME menu.  
DVD1  
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
NAME  
2. When the INPUT NAME menu opens, press the remote control ꢁ  
Restores the factory-default name of the selected input. Factory-  
default input names correspond to front-panel and remote control  
input selection button labels.  
or buttons to highlight the RESTORE DEFAULT NAME option.  
3. Press thearrow button to select this option. The message:  
“PRESS MENU V TO RESTORE INPUT NAME” appears in the on-  
screen and front-panel displays.  
4. Press thebutton to restore the factory-default name and close  
the message. (Press thebutton to close the message without  
restoring the factory-default name of the selected input.)  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Setup  
ASSIGNING AUDIO & VIDEO INPUT CONNECTORS  
The MC-12 has 12 inputs, each of which can be assigned to any (depending on compatibility) of its 13 digital audio, 8 analog audio, 5  
composite video, 8 S-video, or 4 component video input connectors.  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 DIGITAL IN  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
DVD1  
COAX-1  
COAX-2  
COAX-3  
COAX-4  
COAX-5  
COAX-6  
OPTICAL-1  
OPTICAL-2  
OPTICAL-3  
OPTICAL-4  
OPTICAL-5  
OPTICAL-6  
AES/EBU  
NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
VCR  
CD  
FILM  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
RECORD ADVANCED  
The table below indicates the INPUT SETUP menu parameters that  
can be used to assign audio and video input connectors. The ANLG  
IN LVL parameter can be used to adjust 2-channel and 5.1 analog  
audio input levels for the selected input.  
Note:  
The digital audio input connectors are compatible with PCM (44.1, 48,  
88.2, and 96kHz), Dolby Digital and DTS(-ES) sources. The digital  
audio input connectors are not compatible with MPEG or MP3 sources.  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
DIGITAL IN  
COAX-1 TO 6, OPTICAL-1 TO 6, AES/EBU, NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COAX-1 to 6, OPTICAL-1 to 6, AES/EBU, NONE  
ANALOG-1 to 8, 5.1 ANLG (6-8), LIVE!, NONE  
AUTO, -18dB to +12dB  
DVD1  
DIGITAL IN  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
Opens the DIGITAL IN menu, to assign a digital audio input  
connector for the selected input. A digital audio input connector  
must be assigned if no analog audio input connector is assigned.  
COMPOSITE-1 to 5, S-VIDEO-1 to 8, NONE  
COMPONENT IN COMPONENT-1 to 4  
When no analog audio input connector is assigned, the MC-12  
automatically sets the:  
MAIN ADV menu INPUT SELECT parameter to DIGITAL  
INPUT SELECT menu ZONE2 IN parameter to DIGITAL  
INPUT SELECT menu RECORD IN parameter to DIGITAL  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Setup  
Lexicon  
ASSIGNING AUDIO & VIDEO INPUT CONNECTORS (continued)  
ANALOG IN  
ANALOG-1 TO 8, 5.1 ANLG (6-8), LIVE!, NONE  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
ANALOG IN  
SETUP  
Opens the ANALOG IN menu, to assign an analog audio input  
connector for the selected input. An analog audio input connector  
must be assigned if no digital audio input connector is assigned.  
When no digital audio input connector is assigned, the MC-12  
automatically sets the:  
MAIN ADV menu INPUT SELECT parameter to ANALOG  
INPUT SELECT menu ZONE2 IN parameter to ANLG  
INPUT SELECT menu RECORD IN parameter to ANLG  
The appearance of the ANALOG IN menu depends on the configu-  
ration of the analog audio input connectors.  
The ANALOG IN menu (A below) appears when the REAR  
PANEL CONFIG menu 8 STEREO INPUTS option is selected.  
Note:  
LIVE! cannot be selected until LIVE! CALIBRATION is run. When the  
ANALOG IN selection is LIVE!, no other analog inputs (1-8) or digital  
inputs can be selected for that input.  
The ANALOG IN menu (B below) appears when the REAR  
PANEL CONFIG menu 5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG option is  
selected.  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
DVD1 ANALOG IN  
DVD1 ANALOG IN  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
OR  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
ANALOG-1  
ANALOG-2  
ANALOG-3  
ANALOG-4  
ANALOG-5  
ANALOG-6  
ANALOG-7  
ANALOG-8  
NONE  
ANALOG-1  
ANALOG-2  
ANALOG-3  
ANALOG-4  
ANALOG-5  
5.1 ANLG (6-8)  
NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
VCR  
CD  
FILM  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
LIVE!  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE!  
B
MAIN ADVANCED  
A
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
RECORD ADVANCED  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Setup  
ANLG IN LVL  
AUTO, -18 to +12 dB  
Note:  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
ANGL IN LVL  
Adjustments made on the ANLG IN LVL menu are applied to the stereo  
analog audio input connector assigned for the selected input. When  
another stereo analog audio input connector is assigned, these  
adjustments are automatically applied to the new connector.  
Opens the ANLG IN LVL menu, to adjust the 2-channel (and  
5.1-channel when the MAIN ADVANCEDANALOG BYPASS  
parameter is set to OFF) analog audio input levels for the selected  
input. Analog audio sources have a wide range of levels. To  
compensate, the MC-12 allows independent input level adjustment  
of each stereo analog audio input connector. The input level of the  
5.1-channel analog audio input connector is only adjustable when  
the ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF.  
AUTO  
ON, OFF  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
ANGL IN LVL  
AUTO  
Provides automatic adjustment of 2-channel (and 5.1-channel  
when the MAIN ADVANCEDANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to  
OFF) analog audio input levels. When set to ON, the input levels are  
automatically monitored and optimized. When the input signal is  
too high, the input levels are quickly decreased to avoid overload.  
When the input signal is too low, the input levels are slowly  
increased to maximize the signal-to-noise ratio and dynamic range.  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
AUTO  
ON, OFF  
MANUAL  
AUTO GAIN*  
-18 to +12dB  
-18 to +12dB  
* This parameter cannot be adjusted.  
When set to OFF, the 2-channel and 5.1 analog audio input levels  
are not automatically monitored and optimized. Instead, input  
levels must be adjusted with the ANLG IN LVL MANUAL parameter.  
SETUP  
INPUT SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
DVD1 ANLG IN LVL  
ON  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
OFF  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
ON  
+0dB  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
-18 to +12dB  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
+0.0dB  
AUTO GAIN  
L
R
dB  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
FILM  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
-45  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
RECORD ADVANCED  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup  
Lexicon  
ASSIGNING AUDIO & VIDEO INPUT CONNECTORS (continued)  
When the AUTO parameter is OFF, the AUTO GAIN parameter  
indicates the amount of input level adjustment as set by the  
MANUAL parameter.  
MANUAL  
-18 to +12 dB  
DVD1  
MANUAL  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
ANGL IN LVL  
Provides manual adjustment of 2-channel (and 5.1-channel when  
the MAIN ADVANCEDANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF)  
analog audio input levels. Lower levels cause more noise, while  
higher levels pose a risk of overload distortion. When manual  
adjustments are made, the MC-12 automatically sets the ANLG IN  
LVL menu AUTO parameter to OFF, deactivating automatic input  
level adjustment. Manual input level adjustments are retained when  
the AUTO parameter is ON.  
When AUTO GAIN is set to OFF  
DVD1 ANLG IN LVL  
OFF  
+3dB  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
The MANUAL parameter...  
is reflected by the AUTOGAIN value  
+3.0dB  
AUTO GAIN  
Note:  
When the AUTO parameter is ON, the AUTO GAIN parameter  
continues to indicate the amount of manual input level adjustment  
until automatic adjustments have been made.  
When the AUTO parameter is ON, the MC-12 will not make adjustments  
that exceed the ANLG IN LVL menu MANUAL parameter setting.  
LEVEL METERS  
AUTO GAIN  
DVD1  
AUTO GAIN  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
ANGL IN LVL  
Indicate fluctuating input levels in the front left (L) and front right (R)  
channels for the selected input. Meters are also present for center  
(C), side left (SL), side right (SR), and sub (LFE) when the input is set  
up for 5.1-analog. Like the STATUS menu level meters, ANLG IN LVL  
menu level meters indicate input levels for both analog and digital  
audio sources. However, ANLG IN LVL menu input level adjustments  
only affect 2-channel (or 5.1-channel sources when the MAIN  
ADVANCEDANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF) analog  
audio sources.  
Indicates the current amount of input level adjustment for the  
selected 2-channel (and 5.1-channel when the MAIN ADVANCEDꢀ  
ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF) analog audio input  
connector. This parameter cannot be directly adjusted. When the  
ANLG IN LVL menu AUTO parameter is ON, the AUTO GAIN  
parameter indicates the amount of automatic input level  
adjustment.  
When AUTO GAIN is set to ON  
Level meters appear in combinations of green, yellow and red when  
the on-screen display is configured for a blue-screen background.  
Green indicates low levels; yellow indicates normal levels; and red  
indicates the onset of overload. Occasional flashes from yellow into  
red are normal peak indicators. Level meters appear in white when  
the on-screen display is not configured for a blue-screen  
background.  
DVD1 ANLG IN LVL  
The AUTO parameter...  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
ON  
+0dB  
is reflected by the AUTOGAIN value  
AUTO GAIN  
+0.0dB  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MC-12  
Setup  
VIDEO IN  
COMPOSITE-1 TO 5, S-VIDEO-1 TO 8, NONE  
COMPONENT IN  
COMPONENT 1 to 4  
DVD1  
DVD1  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
Opens the VIDEO IN menu, to assign a composite or S-video input  
connector for the selected input.  
Opens the COMPONENT IN menu, to assign a component video  
input connector for the selected input.  
Note:  
Note:  
Composite video output connectors are available only when a  
composite video source is present.  
Component video output connectors are only available when a  
component video source is present.  
S-video output connectors are available when an S-video or Com-  
posite source is present.  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 VIDEO IN  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
COMPOSITE-1  
COMPOSITE-2  
COMPOSITE-3  
COMPOSITE-4  
COMPOSITE-5  
S-VIDEO-1  
S-VIDEO-2  
S-VIDEO-3  
S-VIDEO-4  
S-VIDEO-5  
S-VIDEO-6  
S-VIDEO-7  
S-VIDEO-8  
NONE  
DVD1  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
VCR  
CD  
FILM  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
RECORD ADVANCED  
DVD1 COMPONENT IN  
COMPONENT-1  
COMPONENT-2  
COMPONENT-3  
COMPONENT-4  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
SELECTING PREFERRED LISTENING MODES  
The MC-12 allows the selection of five preferred listening modes for  
each Main Zone input: one listening mode each for 2-channel,  
Dolby Digital, DTS(-ES), 5.1-channel analog, and MIC (LIVE!)  
sources. The table below indicates the INPUT SETUP menu param-  
eters that can be used to select preferred listening modes.  
When a preferred listening mode is selected, it is activated  
whenever a new input is selected or an appropriate input source is  
present. (In the menus at the bottom of the page, the INPUT SETUP  
menu has been modified for the following examples.)  
The following example describes when a preferred listening mode is  
activated:  
Preferred Listening Mode Selection Parameters  
2-CH Selects a preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources  
If the DVD1 input is selected and a 2-channel source is present, the  
L7 FILM listening mode is activated. If a 5.1-channel analog source  
is present, the 5.1a L7 FILM listening mode is activated. If a  
DTS(-ES) source is present, the DTS(-ES) L7 FILM listening mode is  
activated.  
Selects a preferred listening mode for Dolby Digital sources  
Selects a preferred listening mode for DTS(-ES) sources  
D
5.1a Selects a preferred listening mode for 5.1-channel analog sources  
MIC Selects a preferred listening mode for microphone source (LIVE!)  
Menus showing DVD1 parameters selected as preferred listening modes.  
MAIN MENU  
INPUT SETUP  
SETUP  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
NAME  
DVD1  
COAX1  
NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
DVD1 2-CH MODE  
AUTO  
FILM  
TV  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
PLII +  
PLII MOVIE  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
FILM  
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
VCR  
CD  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
D
PLII MUSIC  
5.1a  
MIC  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
PL +  
PRO LOGIC  
NIGHTCLUB  
CONCERT HALL  
CHURCH  
DVD1  
D MODE  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
5.1 FILM  
5.1  
5.1  
TV  
MUSIC  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
2-CH SURROUND  
2-CHANNEL  
MONO LOGIC  
MONO SURROUND  
MONO  
DVD1  
MODE  
FILM  
MUSIC  
DVD1 5.1a MODE  
DIGITAL  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
USE LAST  
FILM  
MUSIC  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
5.1 MONO SURR  
5.1 MONO  
DVD1 MIC MODE  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! LARGE  
USE LAST  
2-CHAN  
USE LAST  
USE LAST  
USE LAST  
3-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
MC-12  
Setup  
2-CH  
SETUP  
D
SETUP  
DVD1  
D
INPUTS  
DVD1  
INPUTS  
2-CH  
Opens the 2-CH MODE menu, which selects a preferred listening  
mode for 2-channel input sources. The MC-12 activates the  
preferred listening mode whenever a new input is selected or a new  
2-channel source is present. When set to USE LAST, the MC-12  
automatically uses the listening mode that was activated the last  
time a 2-channel source was present.  
Opens the Dolby DIGITAL MODE menu, to select a preferred  
listening mode for Dolby Digital input sources. The MC-12  
automatically activates the preferred listening mode whenever a  
new input is selected or a new Dolby Digital source is present.  
When the  
D parameter is set to USE LAST:  
Note:  
The MC-12 automatically uses the Dolby Digital listening mode  
that was activated the last time a Dolby Digital source was  
present.  
The remote control 2 CH button toggles between the 2-CHANNEL  
listening mode and the previous listening mode, and ignores the USE  
LAST setting. Instead, it uses the listening mode (for example, L7 FILM)  
that was activated before the 2-CHANNEL listening mode.  
If the 5.1 THX MUSIC listening mode was activated the last  
time a Dolby Digital source was present, then the 5.1 THX  
MUSIC listening mode is used. Normally, the 5.1 THX MUSIC  
listening mode cannot be selected as the preferred listening  
mode for Dolby Digital sources.  
When the 2-CH parameter is set to USE LAST:  
A DTS Neo:6 listening mode is used if a DTS Neo:6 listening mode  
was activated the last time a 2-channel source was present.  
However, DTS Neo:6 listening modes cannot be selected as the  
preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources.  
The MC-12 requires the presence of a 44.1kHz or 48kHz PCM  
digital source to activate a DTS Neo:6 listening mode. The DTS  
Neo:6 listening modes are not available with 88.2kHz or  
96kHz, Dolby Digital or analog sources.  
A Dolby PLIIx listening mode is used if a Dolby PLIIx listening  
mode was activated the last time a 2-channel source was  
present. However, the Dolby PLIIx listening modes cannot be  
selected as the preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources.  
3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup  
Lexicon  
SELECTING PREFERRED LISTENING MODES (continued)  
5.1a  
DVD1  
5.1a  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
Opens the 5.1a MODE menu, which selects a preferred listening  
mode for 5.1-channel analog input sources. The MC-12 automati-  
cally activates the preferred listening mode whenever a new input is  
selected or a new 5.1-channel analog source is present.  
Opens the DTS(-ES) MODE menu, which selects a preferred  
listening mode for DTS(-ES) input sources. The MC-12 automati-  
cally activates the preferred listening mode whenever a new input is  
selected or a new DTS(-ES) source is present.  
When the DTS(-ES) parameter is set to USE LAST:  
When the 5.1a parameter is set to USE LAST:  
The MC-12 uses the listening mode that was activated the last  
time a DTS(-ES) source was present.  
The MC-12 uses the listening mode that was activated the last  
time a 5.1-channel analog source was present.  
The DTS THX MUSIC listening mode is used if this listening  
mode was activated the last time a DTS(-ES) source was  
present. Normally, the DTS THX MUSIC listening mode cannot  
be selected as the preferred listening mode for DTS(-ES)  
sources.  
The 5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode is used if this listening  
mode was activated the last time a 5.1-channel analog source  
was present. Normally, the 5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode  
cannot be selected as the preferred listening mode for 5.1-  
channel analog sources.  
MIC  
DVD1  
MIC  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
Opens the MIC MODE menu, which selects a preferred listening  
mode for the LIVE! source. The MC-12 automatically activates the  
preferred listening mode when the ANALOG IN selection is LIVE!  
When the MIC parameter is set to USE LAST:  
The MC-12 uses the listening mode that was activated the last  
time a MIC source was present.  
3-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Setup  
CONFIGURING ADVANCED INPUT SETTINGS  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 MAIN ADV  
DIGITAL  
ANALOG  
AUTO  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
DIGITAL  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
AUTO  
OFF  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
OFF  
VCR  
CD  
ON  
OFF  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
FILM  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
ANLG  
DMIX  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
The MC-12 allows the assignment of one digital and one analog  
audio input connector for each input. The table below indicates the  
INPUT SETUP menu parameters that can be used to control the  
interaction of these connectors, as well as other advanced Main  
Zone, Zone 2, and Record Zone input settings.  
The parameters on the left side of the MAIN ADV menu are identical  
regardless of which input is selected. The parameter settings on the  
right side are adjustable. The MAIN ADV menu shown in the  
Appendix indicates factory-default parameter settings for each input.  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
DIGITAL, ANALOG, AUTO  
ON, OFF  
AUTO, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
Refer to the next column  
DIGITAL, ANLG, DMIX  
DIGITAL, ANLG, DMIX  
Refer to 3-20  
RECORD ADVANCED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
MAIN ADVANCED  
The MAIN ADV menu controls the interaction of the digital and analog  
audio input connectors assigned to the current Main Zone input, and  
other advanced Main Zone input settings.  
3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Setup  
Lexicon  
CONFIGURING ADVANCED ZONE SETTINGS (continued)  
When LIVE! is the selected analog input, the MAIN  
ADVANCED INPUT SELECT parameter is forced to ANALOG  
and ANALOG BYPASS is disabled.  
INPUT SELECT  
DIGITAL, ANALOG, AUTO  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
MAIN ADVANCED  
INPUT SELECT  
Controls the interaction of the digital and analog audio input  
connectors assigned to the current Main Zone input. The table on  
the next page describes INPUT SELECT parameter settings.  
When OFF, the MC-12 passes analog input signals through A/D  
conversion and internal processing before passing them to the  
Main Zone audio output connectors. This allows analog  
sources to use bass management, speaker crossovers, speaker  
distance calibration, and tone controls.  
Note:  
Note:  
When the Shift button activates the shift command bank, the 7/5  
button adjusts the INPUT SELECT parameter by cycling through the  
DIGITAL, ANALOG, and AUTO settings.  
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the 2CH button  
toggles ANALOG BYPASS between ON and OFF.  
ANALOG BYPASS  
ON, OFF  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
AUTO, OFF  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ANALOG BYPASS  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
MAIN ADVANCED  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
Forces analog sources to bypass A/D conversion and internal  
processing. When ON, analog input signals pass directly to the  
Main Zone audio output connectors.  
Controls the passage of anamorphic trigger signals present in some  
video sources. When set to AUTO, the MC-12 allows anamorphic  
video input signals to pass through the S-video switcher, enabling  
compatible display devices to automatically switch between  
anamorphic and non-anamorphic display modes.  
When a 2-channel analog source is present, analog input signals  
pass directly to the Front L/R output connectors.  
When OFF, the MC-12 prevents anamorphic video input signals  
from passing through the S-video switcher, preventing compatible  
display devices from automatically switching between anamorphic  
and non-anamorphic display modes.  
When a 5.1-channel analog source is present, analog input  
signals pass to the Main Zone audio output connectors as  
indicated in the tables on pages 2-7 and 3-59.  
3-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Setup  
INPUT SELECT PARAMETER SETTINGS  
DIGITAL  
ANALOG  
AUTO  
The MC-12 sends the digital audio from the The MC-12 sends the analog audio from the The MC-12 toggles between sending digital or  
assigned input to the Main Zone audio assigned input to the Main Zone audio output analog audio input to the Main Zone audio output  
output connectors. The assigned analog connectors. The assigned digital audio input connectors based on the input source that is  
audio input connector is ignored.  
connector is ignored.  
present.  
The digital audio input connectors are Note the following:  
Example:  
compatible with PCM (44.1, 48, 88.2,  
The MC-12 automatically sets the INPUT  
SELECT parameter to ANALOG when no  
digital audio input connector is assigned.  
The MC-12 selects the assigned digital  
and 96kHz), Dolby Digital, and DTS(-ES)  
sources. The digital audio input  
connectors are not compatible with  
MPEG or MP3 sources.  
audio input when a compatible digital  
source is present. The MC-12 does not  
select the assigned analog audio input  
when a compatible digital source is  
present.  
The  
INPUT  
SETUP ANALOG  
IN  
parameter can assign an analog audio  
input connector for the selected input.  
Note the following:  
The MC-12 selects the assigned analog  
audio input connector when no compatible  
digital source is present.  
When LIVE! is the selected analog input,  
the MAIN ADVANCED INPUT SELECT  
parameter is forced to ANALOG and  
ANALOG BYPASS is disabled.  
The MC-12 automatically sets the  
INPUT SELECT parameter to DIGITAL  
when no analog audio input  
connector is assigned.  
The MC-12 selects the assigned analog  
connector if no digital source is present.  
The INPUT SETUP DIGITAL IN  
parameter can assign a digital audio  
input connector for the selected  
input.  
The MC-12 selects the assigned analog  
audio input connector when an analog  
source, such as an SACD, is present.  
Note the following:  
The MC-12 automatically sets the MAIN  
ADVANCED INPUT SELECT parameter to  
AUTO when both digital and analog audio  
input connectors are assigned.  
Use the AUTO setting for components, such as  
DVD/SACD players, that generate both digital  
and analog output signals.  
3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
CONFIGURING ADVANCED ZONE SETTINGS (continued)  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
ON, OFF  
COMPONENT OSD  
ON, OFF  
DVD1  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
DVD1  
COMPONENT OSD  
MAIN ADVANCED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
Controls the on-screen display aspect ratio when the display device  
is connected to a Main Zone S-Video output connector. Aspect ratio  
refers to the size of the picture or the display device screen. A 4:3  
aspect ratio is almost square. A 16:9 aspect ratio, often referred to  
as widescreen, is almost twice as wide as it is high.  
Controls the appearance of the on-screen display when the display  
device is connected to the component video output connector.  
When ON, the display device shows the on-screen display as a 480i  
video signal on a full blue screen background. To minimize viewing  
distractions, the two-line status does not appear in the on-screen  
display. When OFF, the display device does not show the on-screen  
display, including the two-line status.  
When ON, the on-screen display appears in a 4:3 aspect ratio  
regardless of the incoming video input signal. When OFF, the on-  
screen display appears in the same aspect ratio as the incoming  
video input signal.  
Note:  
When the ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu BACKGROUND parameter is  
OFF, the display device using the component video output connector  
will not show the on-screen display.  
The on-screen display appears horizontally stretched across the  
display device screen when all of the following conditions are  
present:  
ZONE2 IN & RECORD IN  
DIGITAL, ANLG, DMIX  
OR  
The S-VIDEO OSD (4:3) parameter is OFF.  
An anamorphic video input signal is present.  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
Controls the interaction of the digital and analog audio input  
connectors assigned to the current Zone 2 and Record Zone inputs.  
The table of the next page describes ZONE2 and RECORD IN  
parameter settings.  
A 16:9 display device (widescreen) is connected to an S-video  
output connector.  
CAUTION!  
When the ZONE2 or RECORD IN parameter is set to  
DIGITAL or ANLG, the MC-12 recognizes some DTS-  
encoded sources as audio signals (not data signals) and  
outputs loud digital noise from the Zone 2 or Record Zone  
audio output connectors.  
3-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
MC-12  
Setup  
ZONE2 & RECORD IN PARAMETER SETTINGS  
DIGITAL  
ANLG (Analog)  
DMIX (Downmix)  
The MC-12 passes a downmixed version of Main Zone audio to the  
Zone 2 or Record Zone audio output connectors. Zones cannot be  
independently monitored. Downmixing is possible when all of the  
following conditions are met:  
The MC-12 passes digital audio The MC-12 passes analog audio from  
from the the assigned input to the the assigned input to the Zone 2  
the Zone 2 or Record Zone audio or Record Zone audio output  
output connectors. The assigned connectors. The assigned digital audio  
analog audio input is ignored. input is ignored. Zones can be  
Zones can be independently independently monitored.  
monitored.  
The same input is selected in both Main Zone and Zone 2 or in  
both Main Zone and Record Zone. Otherwise, the Zone 2 or  
Record Zone audio output connectors will mute.  
Note the following:  
The 5.1a BYPASS listening mode is not activated.  
Note the following:  
The MC-12 passes analog sources  
to all Zone 2 or Record Zone  
audio output connectors.  
The MC-12 passes digital  
sources to all Zone 2 or Record  
Zone audio output connectors.  
Note the following:  
A downmix of all channels is sent to Zone 2.  
The MC-12 passes analog input  
signals directly to the Zone 2 or  
Record Zone analog audio output  
connectors. The MC-12 converts  
analog input signals to digital  
(A/D conversion) before passing  
them to the Record Zone digital  
audio output connectors.  
The MC-12 passes digital input  
signals directly to the Record  
Zone digital audio output  
connectors. The MC-12 sends  
digital input signals through  
D/A conversion before passing  
them to the Zone 2 or Record  
Zone analog audio output  
connectors.  
Main Zone listening mode activation affects the Zone 2 and  
Record Zone audio output connectors. For example, when the  
MONO listening mode is activated, the Zone 2 and Record Zone  
audio output connectors will generate mono output signals.  
Set the ZONE2 IN and RECORD IN parameters to DMIX when  
using a playback device (DVD player) that does not have built-in  
Dolby Digital or DTS(-ES) decoding, and the recording device is a  
VCR or Personal Video Recorder (PVR).  
When no digital audio input is  
assigned, ZONE2 IN and  
RECORD IN are set to ANALOG.  
The MC-12 automatically downmixes multi-channel sources  
(except LOGIC 7 FILM and MUSIC sources) to stereo output  
signals for listening and recording. Also, 5.1-channel analog  
sources can be downmixed when the MAIN  
ADVANCED ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to OFF. Upon  
playback, these downmixes are compatible with matrix decoders,  
but sound best through a Logic 7 listening mode.  
When no analog audio input is  
assigned, ZONE2 IN and  
RECORD IN are set to DIGITAL.  
The INPUT SETUP menu  
ANALOG IN parameter can be  
used to assign an analog audio  
input connector for the selected  
input.  
The INPUT SETUP menu  
DIGITAL IN parameter can be  
used to assign a digital audio  
input connector for the  
selected input.  
3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Setup  
Lexicon  
CONFIGURING ADVANCED ZONE SETTINGS (continued)  
RECORD ADVANCED  
ANLG IN LVL  
-18 to +12dB  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
RECORD ADVANCED  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
RECORD ADVANCED  
ANLG IN LVL  
Opens the RECORD ADV menu, which configures advanced Record  
Zone input settings.  
Allows adjustment of analog audio input levels for input signals sent to  
the Record Zone digital audio output connectors. Adjustments are  
applied to input signals before passing them to the Record Zone digital  
audio output connectors. This parameter can be adjusted when an input  
source is present to prevent the internal A/D converter from overloading.  
The parameters on the left side of the RECORD ADV menu are  
identical regardless of the selected input. The parameter settings on  
the right side are adjustable. The RECORD ADV menu shown in the  
Appendix indicates factory-default parameter settings.  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
ON, OFF  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
RECORD ADVANCED  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
Allows direct digital recording (digital sources bypass sample rate  
conversion). When ON, digital input signals pass directly to the  
Record Zone digital audio output connectors, preserving the  
original input signal sample rate. When OFF, the sample rate of the  
digital signals is converted, then passed to the Record Zone digital  
audio output connectors. The sample rate of the output signal then  
matches the sample rate of the recording device. DIG OUT RATE  
parameter settings have no effect when the DIGITAL BYPASS  
parameter is set to ON.  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
-18 to +12dB  
ON, OFF  
INPUT, 96kHz, 88.2kHz, 48kHz, 44.1kHz  
BLOCKED, ENABLED  
MAIN MENU  
INPUT SETUP  
SETUP  
DVD1 RECORD ADV  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
-18 to +12dB  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DVD1  
+0dB  
OFF  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
ON  
OFF  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
44.1kHz  
ENABLED  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
INPUT  
96kHz  
88.2 kHz  
48kHz  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
FILM  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
44.1kHz  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
BLOCKED  
ENABLED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
RECORD ADVANCED  
3-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MC-12  
Setup  
DIG OUT RATE  
INPUT, 44.1kHz, 48kHz, 88.2kHz, 96kHz  
RECORD  
BLOCKED, ENABLED  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
RECORD ADVANCED  
DIG OUT RATE  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
DVD1  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD  
Controls the sample rate of digital and analog input signals sent to  
the Record Zone digital audio output connectors. When INPUT is  
selected, the sample rate of input signals is not converted.  
Therefore, the original sample rate is maintained from the input  
connectors through to the Record Zone digital audio output  
connectors.  
Prevents recording device feedback loops. When BLOCKED is  
selected, the MC-12 blocks the Record Zone audio output  
connectors to prevent feedback loops. However, video input signals  
are still passed to the Record Zone video output connectors. When  
ENABLED is selected, audio and video input signals are passed to  
the Record Zone audio and video output connectors.  
When a value is selected, input signals pass through the selected  
value of sample rate conversion, then pass to the Record Zone  
digital audio output connectors. Set the DIG OUT RATE parameter  
to the appropriate value when using a recording format that  
operates on a single sample rate, such as CD-R format (44.1kHz).  
3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
SPEAKER SETUP  
Note:  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
The MC-12 Balanced also includes 10 balanced Main Zone audio  
output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, Subwoofer L/R, Side  
L/R, and Rear L/R. Two additional audio output connectors labeled Aux  
L/R are provided for future expansion.  
Selecting the SETUP menu SPEAKERS option opens the SPEAKER  
SETUP menu, which configures the Main Zone audio output  
connectors for the desired speaker setup. The Main Zone includes  
10 unbalanced audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center,  
LFE, Subwoofer L/R, Side L/R, and Rear L/R. Two additional audio  
output connectors labeled Aux L/R are provided for future  
expansion.  
C
R
O
S
S
OV  
E
R
S
ETUP  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
SPEAKER SETUP  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
RR
80Hz  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
R
SR  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
C
M
SUB  
L
SL  
RL  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
Note:  
SETTING CROSSOVER POINTS  
It is important to set crossover points before calibrating output levels or  
LIVE! Otherwise, setting crossover points afterwards could invalidate  
calibrated output levels and will invalidate the LIVE! calibration.  
SET CROSSOVERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
Selecting the SPEAKER SETUP menu SET CROSSOVERS option  
opens the CROSSOVER SETUP menu, which configures a custom or  
THX speaker setup.  
3-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Setup  
CUSTOM SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
C
R
O
S
S
OV  
E
R
S
ETUP  
FRONT L/R  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
SUB XOVER  
LFE  
80 Hz  
80 Hz  
80 Hz  
80 Hz  
MONO  
80 Hz  
OFF  
INPUTS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
RR
80Hz  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
MANUAL  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
R
SR  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
TRIGGERS  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
LOCK OPTIONS  
C
ULTRA2 SUB OFF  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
BGC  
ASA  
N/A  
APART  
M
SUB  
L
SL  
RL  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
CUSTOM SPEAKER SETUPS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
Selecting the CROSSOVER SETUP menu CUSTOM SETUP option  
opens the CUSTOM SETUP menu, which assigns independent  
crossover points for each Main Zone audio output connector.  
Crossover points can be selected in 10Hz increments within a 30 to  
120Hz range. The graphs shown on the next page indicate the  
frequency response of each crossover point.  
Select the subwoofer crossover point equal to the lowest  
crossover point of any of the other speakers. For example, if  
CUSTOM SETUP menu parameters are set as shown above, set  
the SUB XOVER parameter to 80Hz – the lowest crossover point  
of the other speakers.  
In a custom setup, low frequencies are generally redirected from  
speakers with the highest crossover points to speakers with the  
lowest crossover points. Signals lower than the lowest crossover  
point are redirected to the subwoofer. If the lowest crossover point  
is FULL, low frequency signals, excluding LFE information, are not  
redirected to the subwoofer.  
To configure a custom speaker setup:  
Select the crossover point closest to the low frequency rating of  
the associated speakers. For example, set the FRONT L/R  
parameter to the crossover point closest to the low frequency  
rating of the front speakers.  
Low frequencies between the Subwoofer L/R and any or all of the  
other speaker channels can be duplicated. To do this, select the  
FULL + SUB crossover setting for the front, center, side or rear  
speakers. Making this selection can result in excessive bass.  
3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setup  
Lexicon  
SETTING CROSSOVER POINTS (continued)  
High-pass Filter  
Low-pass Filter  
High-pass filters attenuate low frequencies at 24dB per octave. The curves in the graph  
above indicate the frequency response of each crossover setting. From left to right, the  
curves represent crossover settings from 30Hz to 120Hz. The graph above does not  
show the THX 80Hz crossover point, which is 12dB per octave.  
Low-pass filters attenuate high frequencies at 24dB per octave. The curves in the graph  
above indicate the frequency response of each crossover setting. From left to right, the  
curves represent crossover settings from 30Hz to 120Hz.  
3-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Setup  
C
R
O
S
S
OV  
E
R
S
ETUP  
SETUP  
C
R
O
S
S
OV  
E
R
S
ETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
THX SPEAKER SETUP  
THX SETUP  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
RR
80Hz  
!CAUTION!  
PRESSING THE  
BUTTON WILL  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
RR
80Hz  
FRONT L/R  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
MONO  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MANUAL  
AUTOMATICALLY CHANGE  
THE OUTPUTS TO A THX  
SPEAKER  
R
SR  
R
SR  
SUB XOVER THX 80Hz  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
LFE  
OFF  
ULTRA2 SUB OFF  
N/A  
CONFIGURATION  
C
C
80Hz  
BGC  
ASA  
M
SUB  
M
SUB  
APART  
L
SL  
RL  
80Hz  
L
SL  
RL  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
THX SPEAKER SETUPS  
When a THX speaker setup is selected, the MC-12 applies a THX  
80Hz crossover point with a 12dB-per-octave filter to the Front L/R,  
Center, Side L/R, and Rear L/R output connectors. The MC-12  
applies a THX 80Hz crossover point with a 24dB-per-octave filter to  
the Subwoofer L/R output connectors.  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
Selecting CROSSOVER SETUPTHX SETUP opens the THX SPEAKER  
SETUP screen, which indicates that pressing the arrow button will  
automatically configure the Main Zone audio output connectors for  
a THX speaker setup. You should use THX-certified speakers in a  
THX speaker setup.  
Notes:  
A THX speaker setup is not required to activate THX listening  
modes.  
When the THX SPEAKER SETUP screen opens:  
In the THX SETUP menu, only the REAR L/R, THX ULTRA2 SUB,  
BGC, and ASA parameters can be changed.  
Press thearrow button to configure the Main Zone audio  
output connectors for a THX speaker setup. The THX SETUP  
menu will open on the on-screen display.  
Press thearrow button to close the message without config-  
uring the Main Zone audio output connectors for a THX  
speaker setup.  
3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
SPEAKER SETUP PARAMETERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
or  
The table below indicates the speaker setup parameters for config-  
uring the Main Zone audio output connectors for the desired  
speaker setup. These parameters are available on the CUSTOM  
SETUP and THX SETUP menus.  
Speaker setup parameters perform the same function regardless of  
the selected speaker setup. When a parameter setting is adjusted on  
one menu, the corresponding parameter setting is automatically  
adjusted on the other menu. For example, when a THX speaker  
setup is selected, the speaker setup parameters on the CUSTOM  
SETUP menu are set to THX 80Hz.  
CUSTOM SETUP Menu  
THX SETUP Menu  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Setting  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
THX 80Hz  
FRONT L/R*  
CENTER*  
SIDE L/R*  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R*  
SUB XOVER*  
LFE*  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
MONO  
80Hz  
OFF  
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz  
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE  
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE  
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE  
MONO, STEREO, NONE  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
MONO  
THX 80Hz  
ON  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz, NONE  
MONO  
FULL, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz  
ON, OFF  
THX 80Hz  
ON  
THX ULTRA2 SUB  
BGC  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
N/A†  
APART  
ON, OFF  
N/A†  
ON, OFF  
ASA  
APART, CLOSE, TOGETHER  
APART  
APART, CLOSE, TOGETHER  
* These parameters cannot be adjusted on the THX SETUP menu.  
† When the THX ULTRA2 SUB parameter is set to OFF, the BGC parameter is not available (N/A).  
3-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
MC-12  
Setup  
CUSTOM SETUP  
SETUP  
C
R
O
S
S
OV  
E
R
S
ETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
FRONT L/R  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
SUB XOVER  
LFE  
40Hz  
60Hz  
60Hz  
60Hz  
MONO  
40Hz  
OFF  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
R
SR  
RR
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
C
ULTRA2 SUB OFF  
BGC  
ASA  
N/A  
APART  
M
SUB  
L
SL  
RL  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
SUB XOVER  
SUBWOOFERS L/R  
REAR L/R SPEAKERS  
SIDE L/R SPEAKERS  
CENTER SPEAKER  
FRONT L/R SPEAKERS  
FULL  
MONO  
FULL  
FULL  
FULL  
FULL  
30Hz  
STEREO  
FULL + SUB  
FULL + SUB  
FULL + SUB  
FULL + SUB  
40Hz  
NONE  
30Hz  
30Hz  
30Hz  
30Hz  
50Hz  
40Hz  
40Hz  
40Hz  
40Hz  
60Hz  
50Hz  
50Hz  
50Hz  
50Hz  
70Hz  
60Hz  
60Hz  
60Hz  
60Hz  
80Hz  
70Hz  
70Hz  
70Hz  
70Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
NONE  
80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
NONE  
80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
NONE  
80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the front speakers.  
Otherwise, select the crossover point closest to the low  
frequency rating of the front speakers.  
FRONT L/R  
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
FRONT L/R  
Select FULL + SUB to send a full-range signal to the front  
speakers and duplicate bass frequencies to the SUB L/R  
outputs. (The set crossover point of the SUB L/R parameter  
determines the upper range of duplicate bass.) Selecting the  
FULL + SUB option can result in excessive bass.  
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output  
connectors labeled FRONT L/R when a custom speaker setup is  
selected. Opens the FRONT L/R SPEAKERS menu to select a  
crossover point for the FRONT L/R output connectors.  
3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup  
Lexicon  
SETTING CROSSOVER POINTS (continued)  
SIDE L/R  
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
SIDE L/R  
When a THX speaker setup is selected, a THX 80Hz crossover point  
is applied to the FRONT L/R output connectors, and the FRONT L/R  
parameter cannot be adjusted.  
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output connector  
labeled SIDE L/R when a custom speaker setup is selected. Opens  
the SIDE L/R SPEAKERS menu to select a crossover point for the SIDE  
L/R output connectors.  
CENTER  
FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE  
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the side speakers.  
Otherwise, select the crossover point closest to the low  
frequency rating of the side speakers.  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
CENTER  
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output connector  
labeled CENTER when a custom speaker setup is selected. Opens  
the CENTER SPEAKER menu to select a crossover point for the  
CENTER output connector.  
Select FULL + SUB to send a full-range signal to the side  
speakers and duplicate bass frequencies to the SUB L/R  
outputs. (The set crossover point of the SUB L/R parameter  
determines the upper range of duplicate bass.) Selecting the  
FULL + SUB option can result in excessive bass.  
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the center speaker.  
Otherwise, select the crossover point closest to the low  
frequency rating of the center speaker.  
Select NONE when the speaker setup does not include side  
speakers. The MC-12 will redirect side channel signals to the  
Rear L/R output connectors. If the REAR L/R parameter is also  
set to NONE, the MC-12 will redirect surround channel signals  
to the Front L/R output connectors.  
Select FULL + SUB to send a full-range signal to the center  
speaker and duplicate bass frequencies to the SUB L/R outputs.  
(The set crossover point of the SUB L/R parameter determines  
the upper range of duplicate bass.) Selecting the FULL + SUB  
option can result in excessive bass.  
Note:  
When the SIDE L/R parameter is set to NONE, Dolby Digital Surround  
EX, THX Ultra2, THX Surround EX, DTS(-ES) decoding, the ASA  
parameter, and PLIIx modes are not available.  
Select NONE when the speaker setup does not include a center  
speaker. The MC-12 then redirects center channel signals to the  
Front L/R output connectors – unless the 5.1a BYPASS listening  
mode is activated. In this case, configure the speaker setup with the  
associated DVD-A/SACD player to redirect center channel signals.  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
When a THX speaker setup is selected, a THX 80Hz crossover point  
is applied to the SIDE L/R output connectors, and the SIDE L/R  
parameter cannot be adjusted.  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
When a THX speaker setup is selected, a THX 80Hz crossover point  
is applied to the Center output connector, and the CENTER  
parameter cannot be adjusted.  
3-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Setup  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
C
R
O
S
S
OV  
E
R
S
E
TUP  
THX SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
THX SPEAKER SETUP  
FRONT L/R  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
MONO  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
!CAUTION!  
PRESSING THE  
BUTTON WILL  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
RR
80Hz  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
AUTOMATICALLY CHANGE  
THE OUTPUTS TO A THX  
SPEAKER  
R
SR  
SUB XOVER THX 80Hz  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
LFE  
OFF  
ULTRA2 SUB OFF  
N/A  
CONFIGURATION  
C
BGC  
ASA  
M
SUB  
APART  
L
SL  
RL  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
THX REAR SPEAKERS  
THX 80Hz  
NONE  
REAR L/R FULL, FULL + SUB, 30Hz to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
REAR L/R  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
REAR L/R  
When a THX speaker setup is selected, the REAR L/R parameter  
opens the THX REAR SPEAKERS menu shown above, to activate and  
deactivate the REAR L/R output connectors.  
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output connector  
labeled REAR L/R when a custom speaker setup is selected. Opens  
the REAR L/R SPEAKERS menu to select a crossover point for the  
REAR L/R output connectors.  
Select THX 80Hz to activate and configure the Rear L/R output  
connectors for a 7.1-channel THX speaker setup.  
Select NONE to deactivate the Rear L/R output connectors,  
configuring the Main Zone audio output connectors for a  
5.1-channel THX speaker setup.  
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the rear speakers.  
Otherwise, select the crossover point closest to the low  
frequency rating of the rear speakers.  
Select FULL + SUB to send a full-range signal to the rear  
speakers and duplicate bass frequencies to the SUB L/R  
outputs. (The set crossover point of the SUB L/R parameter  
determines the upper range of duplicate bass.) Selecting the  
FULL + SUB option can result in excessive bass.  
Note:  
When the REAR L/R parameter is set to NONE, Dolby Digital Surround  
EX, THX Ultra2, THX Surround EX, and PLIIx modes, DTS(-ES) decoding,  
and the ASA parameter are not available.  
Select NONE when the speaker setup does not include rear speakers.  
The MC-12 then redirects rear channel signals to the Side L/R output  
connectors. If the SIDE L/R parameter is also set to NONE, surround  
channel signals are sent to the Front L/R output connectors.  
3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setup  
Lexicon  
SETTING CROSSOVER POINTS (continued)  
SUB L/R  
MONO, STEREO, NONE  
SUB XOVER  
FULL, 30 to 120Hz, THX 80Hz, NONE  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
SUB XOVER  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
SUB L/R  
Assigns a crossover point for the Main Zone audio output  
connectors labeled SUBWOOFER L/R when a custom speaker setup  
is selected. Opens the SUB XOVER menu to select a crossover point  
for the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors.  
Configures the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled  
SUBWOOFER L/R for a speaker setup that includes one, two, or no  
subwoofer(s).  
When a custom speaker setup is selected, the SUB L/R parameter  
opens the SUBWOOFERS L/R menu, to select a configuration for the  
SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors.  
Select FULL to send a full-range signal to the subwoofer(s).  
Otherwise, select the crossover point equal to the lowest crossover  
point of the other speakers.  
Select MONO if the speaker setup includes one subwoofer. The  
MC-12 sends low frequency front, center, and surround  
channel signals to the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors.  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
When a THX speaker setup is selected, a THX 80Hz crossover point  
is applied to the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors, and the  
SUB L/R parameter cannot be adjusted.  
Select STEREO if the speaker setup includes two subwoofers.  
The MC-12 sends low frequency front left, center, and  
surround left channel signals to the SUBWOOFER L output  
connector and low frequency front right, center, and surround  
right channel signals to the SUBWOOFER R output connector.  
LFE  
ON, OFF  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
LFE  
Select NONE if the speaker setup does not include a subwoofer.  
The MC-12 redirects low frequency signals to the speakers with  
the lowest crossover points – unless the 5.1a BYPASS listening  
mode is activated. In this instance, configure the speaker setup  
with the associated DVD-A/SACD player to redirect low  
frequency signals.  
Activates and deactivates the Main Zone audio output connector  
labeled LFE when a custom speaker setup is selected.  
When a custom speaker setup is selected:  
Select ON to activate the LFE output connector. LFE information is  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
sent to the LFE output connector.  
When a THX speaker setup is selected, the SUBWOOFER L/R output  
connectors are configured for a speaker setup that includes one  
subwoofer, and the SUB L/R parameter cannot be adjusted.  
Select OFF to deactivate the LFE output connector. LFE signals  
are redirected to the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors. If  
the SUB L/R parameter is set to OFF, LFE signals are redirected  
to the speakers with the lowest crossover point.  
3-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MC-12  
Setup  
THX ULTRA2 SUB  
ON, OFF  
ULTRA2 SUB  
ULTRA2 SUB  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
When a THX speaker setup is selected, the LFE information is redirected to  
the SUBWOOFER L/R output connectors, and the LFE parameter cannot  
be adjusted.  
or  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
Enables boundary gain compensation (BGC) for THX Ultra2-  
certified subwoofers.  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
C
R
O
S
S
OV  
E
R
S
ETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
RR
80Hz  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
R
SR  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
C
M
SUB  
L
SL  
RL  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
THX SETUP  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SPEAKER SETUP  
ON  
OFF  
FRONT L/R  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
THX 80Hz  
FRONT L/R  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
SUB XOVER  
LFE  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
MONO  
80Hz  
OFF  
!CAUTION!  
PRESSING THE  
BUTTON WILL  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
MONO  
APART  
CLOSE  
TOGETHER  
AUTOMATICALLY CHANGE  
THE OUTPUTS TO A THX  
SPEAKER CONFIGURATION  
SUB XOVER THX 80Hz  
LFE  
OFF  
ULTRA2 SUB OFF  
N/A  
ULTRA2 SUB OFF  
BGC  
ASA  
BGC  
ASA  
N/A  
APART  
APART  
Select ON if the subwoofer using the Main Zone audio output  
connectors labeled Subwoofer L/R is THX Ultra2-certified.  
When ON is selected, the BGC parameter can be used to adjust  
boundary gain compensation.  
Select OFF if the subwoofer using the Main Zone audio output  
connectors labeled Subwoofer L/R is not THX Ultra2-certified.  
When OFF is selected, the BGC parameter is not available  
(N/A).  
3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setup  
Lexicon  
To maximize the effectiveness of ASA processing, configure a  
7.1-channel speaker setup so the rear speakers are placed close  
together facing the center of the listening space.  
BGC (BOUNDARY GAIN COMPENSATION)  
ON, OFF  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
BGC  
BGC  
or SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
Select APART if the distance between the rear speakers is  
greater than 4 feet (1.2m).  
Adjusts boundary gain compensation when the THX ULTRA2 SUB  
parameter is set to ON.  
Select CLOSE if the distance between the rear speakers is  
greater than 1 foot (0.3m), but less than 4 feet (1.2m).  
Select TOGETHER if the distance between the rear speakers is  
less than 1 foot (0.3m).  
Select ON to apply a highpass 55Hz filter to all Main Zone  
audio output connectors and listening modes.  
Select OFF, and no filtering is applied to the Main Zone audio  
output connectors and listening modes.  
You can use the remote control 7/5 button to toggle between  
7- and 5-channel playback. When you use the 7/5 button , the  
MC-12 automatically:  
Note:  
Activates ASA processing during 7-channel playback.  
Deactivates ASA processing during 5-channel playback.  
Switches between the 5.1 THX ULTRA2 and THX, DTS THX ULTRA2  
and DTS THX, or 5.1a THX ULTRA2 and 5.1a THX listening modes.  
BGC compensates for increased bass energy that is caused by the  
proximity of the speakers to the listening room walls.  
ASA (ADVANCED SPEAKER ARRAY)  
ON, OFF  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
ASA  
ASA  
or SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
THX SETUP  
ASA is a proprietary THX technology that processes rear channel signals to  
optimize the listening experience for THX Ultra2 listening modes, including  
5.1 THX ULTRA2, 5.1 THX MUSIC, DTS THX ULTRA2, DTS THX MUSIC,  
5.1a THX ULTRA2, or 5.1a THX MUSIC. Applied to film sources, ASA  
processing blends surround channel signals to optimize ambient and direc-  
tional surround sounds. Applied to music sources, ASA processing places  
surround channel signals on a wide, stable rear soundstage.  
ASA processing is not available unless:  
One of the THX ULTRA2 listening modes is activated.  
Both side and rear speakers are present.  
The ASA parameter can be changed in any mode, but the change  
will have no effect unless the above conditions are met.  
3-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MC-12  
Setup  
CALIBRATING SPEAKER DISTANCES & OUTPUT LEVELS  
The MC-12 offers both automatic and manual calibration of speaker distances and output levels. Calibration helps to ensure accurate output  
signal arrival time and level at the primary listening position. However, it is not a substitute for proper speaker placement.  
Before calibrating speaker distances and output levels:  
SPEAKER CALIBRATION PARAMETERS  
The table on the next page indicates the speaker calibration param-  
eters that can be used to set speaker distances and output levels for  
the speakers connected to the corresponding Main Zone audio  
output connectors. These parameters are available on the speaker  
distance and output level menus shown throughout this section. All  
parameters perform the same function whether automatic or  
manual calibration is selected.  
Set crossover points for the Main Zone audio output connec-  
tors. Setting crossover points afterwards could invalidate  
calibrated output levels. (The CUSTOM or THX SETUP menu  
can be used to set crossover points.)  
Eliminate extraneous noise in the listening space, including  
conversation, air conditioners, and sounds that filter in through  
open doors and windows.  
Move or remove objects – including people – blocking the  
line-of-sight path between the microphones or SPL meter and the  
speakers.  
SPEAKER DISTANCE PARAMETERS +0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
Determine the distance between the primary listening position and  
the speaker connected to the corresponding Main Zone audio  
output connector.  
OUTPUT LEVEL PARAMETERS  
-18.0db to +12.0dB  
Determine the output level of signals sent to the speaker connected  
to the corresponding Main Zone audio output connector.  
3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Setup  
Lexicon  
UNITS  
FEET, METERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
UNITS  
Determines the unit of measurement in which speaker distances are calculated on ALL speaker distance menus. When FEET is selected, the  
MC-12 calculates speaker distances in feet. When METERS is selected, the MC-12 calculates speaker distances in meters. When the UNITS  
parameter setting is adjusted, the MC-12 automatically adjusts speaker distances to the closest available value in the selected unit of  
measurement.  
Speaker Distance Settings  
Output Level Settings  
Default Setting  
Possible Setting  
Default Setting  
Possible Setting  
Parameter  
FRONT L/R  
+0.0ft  
+0.0ft  
+0.0ft  
+0.0ft  
+0.0ft  
+0.0ft  
+0.0ft  
+0.0ft  
N/A†  
N/A†  
FEET  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
+0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
FEET, METERS  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
N/A†  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
CENTER  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE LEFT  
REAR LEFT  
REAR RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
MONO SUB*  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
N/A†  
UNITS  
* When one subwoofer is included in the speaker setup, this parameter is labeled MONO SUB. When two subwoofers are included in the speaker setup, this parameter is labeled SUB LEFT.  
† When a speaker is not included in the speaker setup, the corresponding speaker distance or output level parameter is not available (N/A).  
3-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
MC-12  
Setup  
AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION  
The MC-12 offers automatic calibration of speaker distances, output levels, or both. The table below indicates available automatic calibration  
options. A successful microphone check is required before automatic calibration can be performed.  
Automatic Options  
Details  
MICROPHONE CHECK  
Confirms that the microphones are properly connected and functioning.  
Calculates an average level for the microphones connected to the microphone input connectors,  
allowing the MC-12 to compensate for individual microphone sensitivities during automatic calibration.  
Ensures that microphone levels are consistent, eliminating automatic calibration errors from individual  
microphone levels.  
DISTANCES & LEVELS  
Activates automatic calibration of speaker distances and output levels.  
Offers accurate calibration with minimal interaction, automatically applying calibrated speaker distances  
and output levels.  
Calibrates speaker distances within 0.5 foot (.2m) of the physical distance between the primary listening  
position and the speaker.  
Calibrates individual speaker output levels within +/-0.5dB of each other and overall speaker output  
levels within +/-3.0dB of THX reference levels (75dB).  
DISTANCES  
LEVELS  
Activates automatic calibration of speaker distances.  
Provides a comparison between original and calibrated speaker distances, allowing selection of the  
desired values.  
Calibrates speaker distances within 0.5 foot (.2m) of the physical distance between the primary listening  
position and the speaker.  
Activates automatic calibration of output levels.  
Provides a comparison between original and calibrated output levels, allowing selection of the desired  
values.  
Calibrates individual speaker output levels within +/-0.5dB of each other and overall speaker output  
levels within +/-3.0dB of THX reference levels (75dB).  
3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Setup  
Lexicon  
CONNECTING THE MICROPHONES  
MC-12 Rear Panel  
CAUTION!  
The microphones included in the Lexicon Microphone Kit  
require careful handling. Dropping or otherwise physically  
abusing the microphones might cause errors during use or  
irreparable damage to the microphone.  
The microphone wires also require careful handling. Do not  
sharply bend the wires or place objects on them.  
Never make or break microphone input connections unless  
the MC-12 is powered off with the rear panel power switch  
OR standby mode is activated with the front panel or  
remote control standby button.  
1. Make sure the MC-12 is powered off OR in standby mode.  
2. Connect the microphones included in the Lexicon Microphone  
Kit to the microphone input connectors on the MC-12 rear  
panel as shown above. Make sure the microphone cable plug is  
fully inserted for a solid connection.  
Note the following:  
Automatic calibration requires the microphones included in the  
Lexicon Microphone Kit available at authorized Lexicon dealers.  
Performing automatic calibration with microphones other than  
those in the kit will produce unpredictable results.  
During the microphone check, the microphones will be  
referred to as 1, 2, 3, and 4 based on the input connector to  
which the microphone is connected. You should label the  
microphones for troubleshooting purposes.  
Proper microphone placement is essential to achieving the  
desired automatic calibration results. Pay particular attention to  
the microphone placement instructions and illustrations  
included in this section.  
3. Power on the MC-12 OR deactivate standby mode.  
It is important to read and observe the care and handling docu-  
mentation included with the Lexicon Microphone Kit to ensure  
optimal microphone performance.  
3-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Setup  
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR THE MICROPHONE CHECK  
Refer to the microphone placement examples that begin below to position the microphones for the microphone check.  
PROPER  
microphone positioning for the microphone check  
During the microphone check, position  
the microphones:  
3 As close together as possible  
3 Relatively centered between and equidistant  
from the front left and right speakers  
Rear  
Left  
3 In a clear line-of-sight path with the speakers  
Side  
Left  
Rear  
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and  
other fixtures, where echoes will not obscure  
calibration noise signals  
Right  
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers and  
Side  
Right  
walls, but within 30 feet (9.14m) of all speakers.  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
proper microphone placement during the microphone  
check. All of the microphones are positioned as close  
together as possible in an unobstructed location that is  
equidistant from the front left and right speakers.  
Front  
Left  
Microphone  
Center  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup  
Lexicon  
IMPROPER  
microphone positioning for the microphone check  
During the microphone check, do not:  
7 Separate the microphones  
7 Scatter the microphones throughout the listening  
space  
7 Obstruct the line-of-sight path between the micro-  
phones and the speakers  
Rear  
Left  
7 Position the microphones on the floor, on seat  
cushions, or in locations obstructed by furniture and  
other fixtures, where echoes might obscure  
calibration noise signals  
Side  
Left  
Rear  
Right  
7 Position the microphones within 2 feet (0.61m) of  
speakers and walls or more than 30 feet (9.14m)  
from any one speaker.  
Side  
Right  
Front  
Left  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
improper microphone placement during the microphone  
check. The microphones are scattered throughout the  
listening space rather than positioned as close together as  
possible in a location that is equidistant from the front left  
and right speakers.  
Microphone  
Center  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Setup  
CHECKING THE MICROPHONES  
C
H
E
C
K
M
IC  
GROUP M  
INTO A BU  
MIDDLE O  
PRESS BEGIN  
MIC C CK  
R
O
P
HONES  
PHONES  
E IN THE  
E ROOM  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
I
CR  
O
N
DL
T
F
H
MANUAL  
TO
H
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
E
APART  
Note the following:  
3. Press the arrow button to begin the microphone check. The  
following screens appear in the on-screen display as the micro-  
phone check is performed:  
The MC-12 outputs calibration noise signals between 55 and  
95dB, beginning with 55dB and increasing in 5dB increments  
until the microphones detect the required level. If the calibra-  
tion noise signal becomes too loud, press the arrow button  
to cancel the microphone check.  
CHECKING FOR SILENCE  
Appears in the on-screen display while  
C
H
E
C
K
MICROPHONES  
Although the calibration noise signal is output at a fixed  
volume level, you should set all volume controls for associated  
components (i.e. speakers, subwoofers, and power amplifiers)  
to a reasonable level before performing automatic calibration.  
When the procedure is finished, the MC-12 automatically  
reverts to the last volume level that was selected before  
automatic calibration began.  
the MC-12 determines the relative noise  
level of the listening space and the  
internal noise level of the microphones.  
After eliminating microphones that are  
not detected or not functioning, the MC-12 calculates an aver-  
age level for all microphones.  
CHECKING FOR SILENCE  
PLEASE WAIT  
During automatic calibration, you should refer to the on-screen  
display instead of the front panel display, as additional informa-  
tion and instructions are available on the on-screen display.  
CHECKING MICROPHONES  
Appears in the on-screen display while  
C
H
E
C
K
MICROPHONES  
the MC-12 confirms the microphone  
level calculated during the silence  
check. To do this, the MC-12 sends  
alternating calibration noise signals to  
CHECKING MICROPHONES  
PLEASE WAIT  
1. Select the SPEAKER SETUP menu CHECK MICROPHONES  
option as shown above.  
the front left and right speakers. These signals are output  
between 55 and 95dB, beginning with 55dB and increasing in  
5dB increments until the microphones detect the required  
2. The first CHECK MICROPHONES screen opens in the on-screen  
display, indicating the importance of proper microphone  
placement to achieve accurate automatic calibration results.  
3-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
CHECKING THE MICROPHONES (continued)  
level. If the signal becomes too loud, press the arrow button  
to cancel the microphone check.  
4. Press the and arrow buttons to highlight the desired  
microphone parameter. The MC-12 refers to the microphones  
according to the input connector to which the microphone is  
connected.  
The MC-12 uses the calibration noise signal to eliminate micro-  
phones that register the signal at a level that is too low or too  
high. Then, the MC-12 determines the appropriate output level  
for the calibration noise signal used during automatic calibration.  
5. Press the arrow button to view more detailed results for the  
selected microphone. A message similar to the one shown at  
the bottom of the previous column opens in the on-screen  
display. Refer to the table on the next page for information  
about all possible microphone check messages.  
CHECK MICROPHONES Results  
Appears on-screen when the MC-12 is finished checking the  
microphones. This display indicates the individual check results  
for each microphone.  
Note the following:  
The MC-12 retains the calculated microphone level until the  
SPEAKER SETUP menu is closed. Once this menu is closed,  
another microphone check is required before automatic cali-  
bration can be performed.  
An OK result indicates that the microphone passed the  
microphone check.  
An ERROR result indicates that the microphone did not pass  
the microphone check.  
For best results, you should perform automatic calibration with  
four microphones that have passed the microphone check.  
However, the MC-12 will perform automatic calibration as long  
as at least one microphone passes the microphone check. In  
this circumstance, place the successfully checked microphones  
in the primary listening position.  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
(MICROPHONE)  
OK  
MIC 1  
MIC 2  
MIC 3  
MIC 4  
OK  
OK  
ERROR  
OK  
If a microphone check was successful, do not disconnect the  
microphones from the microphone input connectors. If the  
microphones are disconnected, you should perform the micro-  
phone check again before proceeding to automatic calibration.  
PRESS TO VIEW  
DETAILS  
3-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Setup  
Message  
Description  
Troubleshooting  
The microphone detected the calibration  
noise signal without error.  
N/A  
(MICROPHONE)  
OK  
The MC-12 did not detect the micro-  
phone during the silence check.  
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-  
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.  
(MICROPHONE)  
NOT DETECTED  
The microphone might be damaged. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer for assistance.  
The MC-12 detected the microphone  
during the silence check. However, the  
microphone level determined during the  
silence check was not confirmed during  
the microphone check.  
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-  
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.  
(MICROPHONE)  
SIGNAL TOO LOW  
The microphones might be positioned too far from the front speakers. Refer to the microphone  
placement examples that begin on page 3-42 to confirm that the microphones are appropri-  
ately positioned for the microphone check.  
The microphone might be damaged. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer for assistance.  
The microphone level is more than 20dB  
below the highest microphone level.  
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-  
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.  
(MICROPHONE)  
OUT OF RANGE  
The microphones might be positioned too far from the front speakers. Refer to the microphone  
placement examples that begin on page 3-42 to confirm that the microphones are appropri-  
ately positioned for the microphone check.  
The microphone might be damaged. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer for assistance.  
The microphone level could not be deter-  
mined because of excessive room noise in  
the listening space.  
Eliminate extraneous noises in the listening space, including conversations, air conditioners,  
and sounds that filter in through open doors and windows.  
(MICROPHONE)  
TOO MUCH ROOM NOISE  
The microphone might be damaged. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer for assistance.  
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION  
Proper microphone placement is essential to achieving the desired  
automatic calibration results. Microphone placement determines  
whether the MC-12 calibrates optimal speaker distances and output  
levels for a single listening position, several listening positions in a  
single row, or several listening positions in the listening space.  
Refer to the microphone placement examples that begin on the  
next page to position the microphones for automatic calibration.  
Select the microphone placement that best meets the needs of the  
listening space.  
3-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setup  
Lexicon  
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)  
PROPER  
microphone placement to achieve the best results for a single listening position  
When calibrating for a single listening  
position, place the microphones:  
3 As close together as possible in a single listening  
position (the primary listening position)  
3 At the approximate spot where the listener’s  
head will be during listening  
Rear  
Left  
3 In a clear line-of-sight path with the speakers  
Side  
Left  
Rear  
Right  
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and  
other fixtures, where echoes will not obscure  
calibration noise signals  
Side  
Right  
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers and  
walls, but within 30 feet (9.14m) of all speakers.  
Front  
Left  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
proper microphone placement when calibrating for a  
single listening position. The microphones are  
positioned as close together as possible in a single  
listening position, allowing the MC-12 to calibrate  
optimal speaker distances and output levels for that  
position.  
Microphone  
Center  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Setup  
PROPER  
microphone placement to achieve the best results for multiple listening positions in a single row  
When calibrating for multiple listening  
positions in a single row, position the  
microphones:  
3 At the approximate spot where the listener’s  
head will be during listening  
3 In a clear line-of-sight path with the speakers  
Rear  
Left  
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and  
other fixtures, where echoes will not obscure  
calibration noise signals  
Side  
Left  
Rear  
Right  
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers and  
walls, but within 30 feet (9.14m) of all speakers.  
Side  
Right  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
proper microphone placement when calibrating for  
multiple listening positions in a single row. Each micro-  
phone is positioned in a single listening position within  
a single row, allowing the MC-12 to calibrate optimal  
speaker distances and output levels for that row at the  
expense of a single listening position.  
Front  
Left  
Microphone  
Center  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup  
Lexicon  
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)  
PROPER  
microphone placement to achieve the best results for multiple listening positions in multiple rows  
When calibrating for multiple listening  
positions in multiple rows, position the  
microphones:  
3 At the approximate spot where the listener’s  
head will be during listening  
Rear  
Left  
3 In a clear line-of-sight path with the speakers  
Side  
Left  
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and  
other fixtures, where echoes will not obscure  
calibration noise signals  
Rear  
Right  
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers and  
Side  
Right  
walls, but within 30 feet (9.14m) of all speakers.  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
proper microphone placement when calibrating for  
multiple listening positions in multiple rows. Each  
microphone is positioned in a single listening position  
within rows, allowing the MC-12 to calibrate optimal  
speaker distances and output levels for a larger  
listening area at the expense of a single listening  
position.  
Front  
Left  
Microphone  
Center  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Setup  
IMPROPER  
microphone positioning for automatic calibration  
During the automatic calibration, do not:  
7 Arrange the microphones along the perimeter of  
the listening positions or space  
7 Position the microphones in spots where the  
listeners’ heads will not be during listening  
Rear  
Left  
Side  
Left  
7 Obstruct the line-of-sight path between the  
Rear  
Right  
microphones and the speakers  
7 Position the microphones on the floor, on seat  
cushions, or in locations obstructed by furniture  
and other fixtures, where echoes might obscure  
calibration noise signals  
Side  
Right  
7 Position the microphones within 2 feet (0.61m) of  
speakers and walls or more than 30 feet (9.14m)  
from any one speaker.  
Front  
Left  
Microphone  
Center  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
improper microphone placement during the micro-  
phone check. The microphones are positioned on the  
floor along the perimeter of the listening space,  
making it difficult for the MC-12 to calibrate optimal  
speaker distances and output levels for the actual  
listening positions.  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup  
Lexicon  
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)  
IMPROPER  
microphone positioning for automatic calibration  
During the automatic calibration, do not:  
7 Arrange the microphones along the perimeter of  
the listening positions or space  
7 Position the microphones at spots where the  
listeners’ heads will not be during listening  
Rear  
Left  
7 Obstruct the line-of-sight path between the  
Side  
Left  
Rear  
Right  
microphones and the speakers  
7 Position the microphones on the floor, on seat  
cushions, or in locations obstructed by furniture  
and other fixtures, where echoes might obscure  
calibration noise signals  
Side  
Right  
7 Position the microphones within 2 feet (0.61m) of  
speakers and walls or more than 30 feet (9.14m)  
from any one speaker.  
Front  
Left  
Microphone  
Center  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
improper microphone placement during the microphone  
check. The microphones are positioned on seat cushions  
rather than in spots where the listener’s heads will be  
during listening.  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Setup  
PERFORMING AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
A
U
T
O
SPE  
DISTANCES  
DISTANCES
OUTPUT LE EL  
PLACE MICROPHONES  
A
K
E
R
SETUP  
A
U
T
O
SPE  
!CA  
HIGH AU  
YOU WILL E 10 SEC  
TO LEAVE  
SIT QU  
PRESS
A
K
E
R
SETUP  
N!  
IOLEVELS  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
&
L
E
VELS  
U
D
TI  
O
TEST WILL BEGIN IN  
10  
V  
S
MANUAL  
T  
H
A
V
PRESS TO SKIP  
COUNTDOWN  
IN PRIMARY LISTENING  
HE  
R
OOM OR  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
I
E
TLY  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
POSITIONS  
APART  
T
O
BEGIN  
COUNTDOWN  
Follow the procedures in the appropriate table column for the desired type of automatic calibration.  
STEP  
DISTANCES  
DISTANCES & LEVELS  
LEVELS  
Select the SPEAKER SETUP menu AUTOMATIC option as shown in the menu illustration above.  
If a microphone check is successful, the AUTO SPEAKER SETUP menu becomes available on the on-screen display. Press  
the or arrow button to highlight the automatic calibration option you want. Then, press the arrow button to select  
this option. Refer to the table on page 3-35 for more information about automatic calibration options.  
M I C C H E C K R E Q U I R E D  
FOR AUTO CALIBRATION  
1
If a microphone check is unsuccessful, one of the error messages shown at the right appears on the on-screen display, indicat-  
ing that a successful microphone check is required before automatic calibration is available, and also the reason the previous  
check failed. If this occurs, go back to “Connecting the Microphones” on page 3-36 and work your way forward to this page.  
NO MICROPHONE  
DETECTED  
The following AUTO SPEAKER SETUP messages display on-screen before automatic calibration begins:  
The !CAUTION! HIGH AUDIO LEVELS message indicates that the MC-12 generates loud calibration noise signals during automatic calibration. If the  
signals become too loud, press the arrow button to cancel automatic calibration. Press the arrow button to open the next AUTO SPEAKER  
SETUP menu.  
2
The countdown display notifies you that automatic calibration will begin in 10 seconds. The primary reason for the 10 second delay is to give you time  
to leave the listening space before automatic calibration begins. If you choose to remain in the room, your movements could affect the calibration  
results. If you leave the room, you can return in about 10 minutes (the calibration procedure should be completed). Press the arrow button to  
skip the countdown and begin automatic calibration. The MC-12 automatically activates automatic calibration when the countdown ends.  
3-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup  
Lexicon  
PERFORMING AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)  
SETTING DISTANCES  
SETTING DISTANCES  
SETTING LEVELS  
SETTING LEVELS  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
N/A  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
12.0ft  
10.5ft  
12.0ft  
4.5ft  
ERROR  
6.0ft  
4.5ft  
N/A  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
N/A  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
-2.0dB  
ERROR  
-2.0dB  
-4.5dB  
-3.0dB  
-3.0dB  
-4.5dB  
N/A  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
STEP  
DISTANCES  
DISTANCES & LEVELS  
LEVELS  
This step does not occur when the AUTO  
SPEAKER SETUP menu LEVELS option is  
selected.  
The SETTING DISTANCES screen displays when the MC-12 calibrates speaker distances.  
During speaker distance calibration, the MC-12 sends calibration noise signals to the Main Zone  
audio output connectors in the order shown on the SETTING DISTANCES screen. The cursor auto-  
matically scrolls downward through speaker calibration parameters, highlighting each parameter  
while the MC-12 calculates a distance for the corresponding speaker. As it finishes each parameter,  
the MC-12 enters the calibrated value or an ERROR message to the right of the parameter label.  
3
Because of the way low frequency signals propagate in most listening spaces, automatic speaker dis-  
tance calibration often produces unreliable results for subwoofers and LFE subwoofers. For this reason  
the MC-12 does not send calibration noise signals to the Subwoofer L/R and LFE output connectors  
during speaker distance calibration. Instead, the MC-12 automatically calibrates subwoofer and LFE  
subwoofer distances to the shortest distance of the other speakers. These distances can be manually  
This step does not occur when the AUTO SPEAKER  
SETUP menu DISTANCES option is selected.  
The SETTING LEVELS screen displays when the MC-12 calibrates output levels.  
The MC-12 sends calibration noise signals to the Main Zone audio output connectors in the  
order shown on the SETTING LEVELS screen. The cursor automatically scrolls downward  
through speaker calibration parameters, highlighting each parameter while the MC-12 calcu-  
lates an output level for the corresponding speaker. As it finishes each parameter, the MC-12  
enters the calibrated value or an ERROR message to the right of the parameter label.  
4
3-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Setup  
DISTANCES  
STEP  
DISTANCES & LEVELS  
LEVELS  
AUTO LEVELS  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP  
AUTO DISTANCES  
FRONT LEFT  
OK  
FRONT LEFT  
OK  
DISTANCES  
LEVELS  
OK  
ERROR  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
-2.0dB  
ERROR  
-2.0dB  
-4.5dB  
-3.0dB  
-3.0dB  
-4.5dB  
N/A  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
12.0ft  
10.5ft  
12.0ft  
4.5ft  
ERROR  
6.0ft  
4.5ft  
N/A  
Refer to the table on page  
3-51 for information about  
all possible speaker calibra-  
tion messages.  
Refer to the table on page  
3-51 for information about  
all possible speaker calibra-  
tion messages.  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
AUTO VALUES APPLIED  
PRESS TO VIEW  
DETAILS  
When the MC-12 is finished calibrating  
speaker distances and output levels, the  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP screen displays,  
indicating the results for each calibration  
procedure.  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
When the MC-12 is finished calibrating  
speaker distances, the AUTO DISTANCES  
screen displays, indicating the results for  
each individual speaker.  
When the MC-12 is finished calibrating  
output levels, the AUTO LEVELS screen  
displays, indicating the results for each  
individual speaker.  
An OK message indicates that no errors  
occurred during the calibration proce-  
dure.  
An ERROR message indicates that a value  
was calculated, but at least one error  
occurred during calibration.  
A value indicates that no errors occurred  
during the calibration procedure.  
A value indicates that no errors occurred-  
during the calibration procedure.  
5
An ERROR message indicates that a value  
was calculated, but at least one error  
occurred during the calibration proce-  
dure.  
An ERROR message indicates that a value  
was calculated, but at least one error  
occurred during the calibration proce-  
dure.  
Press the or arrow button to high-  
light the desired calibration procedure.  
DISTANCES displays the AUTO DIS-  
TANCES screen shown in the left column  
of this table.  
Press the or arrow button to high-  
light the speaker calibration parameter  
you want. Then, press the button to  
view more detailed results for the  
selected speaker. A message similar to  
the one shown above will display.  
Press the or arrow button to high-  
light the desired speaker calibration  
parameter. Then, press the arrow  
button to view more detailed results for  
the selected speaker. A message similar  
to the one shown above displays.  
LEVELS displays the AUTO LEVELS screen  
shown in the right column of this table.  
Press the arrow button to select this  
procedure.  
Refer to the table on 3-51 for informa-  
tion about all possible speaker calibration  
messages.  
Refer to the table on page 3-51 for infor-  
mation about all possible speaker calibra-  
tion messages.  
Refer to the instructions in the appropri-  
ate column to view more detailed results  
for each individual speaker.  
To fine-tune individual speaker distances and output levels, refer to the MANUAL CALIBRATION section that begins on page 3-52. You should also  
configure BASS PEAK LIMITERS parameter settings. (See “SETTING BASS PEAK LIMITERS” on page 3-57.)  
Note:  
3-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
PERFORMING AUTOMATIC CALIBRATION (continued)  
STEP  
DISTANCES  
DISTANCES & LEVELS  
LEVELS  
SET DISTANCES  
AUTO DISTANCES  
AUTO DISTANCES*  
SET LEVELS  
AUTO LEVELS  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP  
AUTO DISTANCES  
ORIGINAL DISTANCES  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
12.0ft  
10.5ft  
12.0ft  
4.5ft  
ERROR  
6.0ft  
4.5ft  
N/A  
DISTANCES  
LEVELS  
OK  
ERROR  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
12.0ft  
10.5ft  
12.0ft  
4.5ft  
ERROR  
6.0ft  
4.5ft  
N/A  
AUTO LEVELS  
ORIGINAL LEVELS  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
-2.0dB  
ERROR  
-2.0dB  
-4.5dB  
-3.0dB  
-3.0dB  
-4.5dB  
N/A  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
AUTO VALUES APPLIED  
PRESS TO VIEW  
DETAILS  
R
C
SR  
RR  
0.0ft  
R
SR  
RR  
0.0dB  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0dB  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0dB  
C
0.0dB  
M
SUB  
M
SUB  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
L
SL RL  
0.0ft  
L
SL RL  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
Use the SET DISTANCES menu to select  
the desired speaker distances.  
Use the AUTO SPEAKER SETUP menu to  
select speaker distances or levels.  
Use the SET LEVELS menu to select the  
desired speaker levels.  
1 Press the arrow button to return to the  
1 Press the arrow button to return to  
1 Press the arrow button to return to  
the SET DISTANCES menu.  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP results screen.  
the SET LEVELS menu.  
6
2 Press the or arrow button to tog-  
gle between calibrated speaker distances  
(AUTO) and original speaker distances.  
The speaker graphics at the bottom of  
the menu update to indicate the selected  
values.  
2 To select the other calibration procedure,  
follow the instructions in Step 5. Otherwise,  
press the button to return to the  
SPEAKER SETUP menu.  
Press the and arrow buttons to  
toggle between calibrated output levels  
(AUTO) and original output levels. The  
speaker graphics at the bottom of the  
menu update to indicate the selected val-  
ues.  
The AUTO DISTANCES screen is shown above  
as an example. The AUTO LEVELS screen can  
be substituted.  
Press the arrow button to apply the  
selected values. A confirmation message  
displays to indicate the applied values.  
3 Press the button to apply the  
selected values. A confirmation message  
displays to indicate the applied values.  
Press the arrow button twice in suc-  
cession to return to the SPEAKER SETUP  
menu.  
4 Press the button twice in succession  
to return to the SPEAKER SETUP menu.  
3-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Setup  
Message  
Description  
Troubleshooting  
The MC-12 successfully calibrated the value  
for the selected speaker without error.  
N/A  
(SPEAKER)  
OK  
The selected speaker is not present in the  
speaker setup  
Set the corresponding CUSTOM or THX SETUP menu parameter to include the selected  
speaker in the speaker setup. (The MC-12 only calibrates values for speakers that are included  
in the speaker setup.)  
(SPEAKER)  
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED  
The microphones detected out-of-phase  
calibration noise signals, but the cali-  
brated value is still accurate.  
Examine speaker/associated amplifier connections to ensure that speaker wires are not crossed.  
(SPEAKER)  
SPEAKER OUT OF PHASE  
Dipolar speakers could cause this error. However, the MC-12 does not report this error unless  
at least half of the microphones detect out-of-phase calibration noise signals.  
Reflections from room objects can cause an out of phase error.  
Drivers intentionally wired out-of-phase.  
The microphones detected calibration  
noise signals at an unusually low level.  
The microphones might be positioned more than 30 feet (9.14m) from the selected speaker or in a  
location where echoes obscure calibration noise signals. Refer to the placement examples on pages  
3-42 to 3-46 to confirm that the microphones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.  
(SPEAKER)  
SIGNAL TOO LOW  
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-  
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.  
The microphones did not detect calibra-  
tion noise signals or the MC-12 could not  
calculate a value.  
Refer to the microphone placement examples on pages 3-42 to 3-46 to confirm that the  
microphones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.  
(SPEAKER)  
UNABLE TO CALCULATE  
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the microphones are properly con-  
nected to the MC-12 and that microphone cable plugs are fully inserted for a solid connection.  
One or more microphones did not detect  
calibration noise signals at a reasonable  
level. The calibrated value could be inac-  
curate.  
Refer to the microphone placement examples on pages 3-42 to 3-46 to confirm that the  
microphones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.  
(SPEAKER)  
MAY NOT BE ACCURATE  
The microphones detected calibration  
noise signals at an unusually high level.  
Decrease associated amplifier volume levels – including (if applicable) powered subwoofer amplifiers.  
(SPEAKER)  
SPKR OUTPUT TOO HIGH  
The microphones may be positioned too close (within 2 feet [0.61m]) of the selected speaker.  
Refer to the microphone placement examples on pages 3-42 to 3-46 to confirm that the micro-  
phones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.  
The microphones detected calibration  
noise signals at an unusually low level.  
Increase associated amplifier volume levels – including (if applicable) powered subwoofer amplifiers.  
(SPEAKER)  
SPKR OUTPUT TOO LOW  
The microphones may be positioned too far away (more than 30 feet [9.14m]) from the  
selected speaker. See the microphone placement examples on pages 3-42 to 3-46 to confirm  
that the microphones are appropriately positioned for automatic calibration.  
3-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setup  
Lexicon  
MANUAL CALIBRATION  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
Selecting the SPEAKER SETUP menu MANUAL option displays the MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP menu, to manually calibrate speaker distances and  
output levels. The table below indicates available manual calibration options.  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
M
A
N
U
A
L
S
P
EA  
SPEAKER DISTANCE  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
K
ER SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
S
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
0.0dB  
R
SR  
RR  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
C
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
0.0dB  
M
SUB  
L
SL RL  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
Manual Options  
DetailsB  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
Provides manual calibration and individual adjustment of speaker distances.  
Provides manual calibration and individual adjustment of output levels.  
INTERNAL NOISE TEST  
Automatically sends an internal calibration noise signal to each Main Zone audio output connector, allowing  
for simultaneous output level adjustment.  
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST  
• Requires an external calibration source such as an audio calibration disc.  
• Activates an appropriate listening mode based on the current Main Zone input source.  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
• Provides amplitude limits for low frequency signals sent to the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled  
Subwoofer L/R and LFE, and low frequency signals redirected to other Main Zone audio output connectors.  
• Protects speakers against input sources that produce low frequency signal peaks.  
3-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
MC-12  
Setup  
PERFORMING MANUAL SPEAKER DISTANCE CALIBRATION  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
Selecting the MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP menu SPEAKER DISTANCES option displays the SPEAKER DISTANCES menu, to manually calibrate  
speaker distances.  
SETUP  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
MAIN MENU  
SPEAKER SETUP  
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
N/A  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
MANUAL  
R
C
SR  
RR  
0.0ft  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
M
SUB  
N/A  
FEET  
L
SL RL  
0.0ft  
METERS  
FEET  
UNITS  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
To manually calibrate speaker distances:  
3. To determine the appropriate speaker distance, measure the  
distance between the primary listening position and the front  
of the speaker.  
1. Follow the menu path shown above to select SPEAKER  
DISTANCES. The SPEAKER DISTANCES menu shown above will  
open on the on-screen display.  
For example, when the FRONT LEFT parameter is selected,  
measure the distance between the primary listening position  
and the front of the front left speaker (connected to the Main  
Zone audio output connector labeled Front L).  
2. Press the or arrow buttons to highlight the desired  
speaker distance parameter. Then, press the arrow button  
to select the highlighted speaker distance parameter.  
4. When the speaker distance has been measured, press the ꢁ  
and arrow buttons to set the parameter to the closest  
available value.  
3-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setup  
Lexicon  
PERFORMING MANUAL OUTPUT LEVEL CALIBRATION  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
Selecting the MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP menu LEVELS CALIBRATION option displays the LEVELS CALIBRATION menu to manually calibrate  
output levels.  
Note the following:  
You should use a Sound Pressure Level (SPL) meter to manually  
calibrate output levels. An SPL meter is a device that measures  
the relative loudness of the speakers to ensure accurate output  
level calibration. SPL meters are available at Radio Shack.  
Output levels for speakers that are not included in the speaker  
setup cannot be adjusted during the internal noise test. These  
output levels can be adjusted during the external noise test,  
but there is no need to do so.  
Output levels should be calibrated from the primary listening  
position, placing the SPL meter at the approximate location  
where the listener’s head will be during listening.  
SETUP  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
MAIN MENU  
SPEAKER SETUP  
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
INTERNAL NOISE TEST  
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
R
SR  
RR  
0.0dB  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
INTERNAL NOISE  
SPEAKER LEVEL ADJUST  
C
!CAUTION!  
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
+0.0dB  
0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
N/A  
M
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
MONO SUB  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
L
SL RL  
0.0dB  
SUB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
UNITS  
N/A  
-18.0 to +12.0dB  
3-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Setup  
INTERNAL NOISE TEST  
INTERNAL NOISE TEST  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
To manually calibrate output levels during the internal noise test:  
Opens the INTERNAL NOISE message shown on the previous page,  
which indicates that the internal noise test generates loud  
calibration noise signals.  
1. Set the SPL meter to “C” weighting and “SLOW” response.  
2. Press the or arrow button to highlight the desired  
output level parameter. Then, quickly press the button to  
select this output level parameter. The horizontal bar graph  
shown on the previous page will open on the on-screen display  
and automatic scrolling will stop.  
When the INTERNAL NOISE message opens:  
Press the arrow button to open the SPEAKER LEVEL ADJUST  
menu shown on the previous page. When the SPEAKER LEVEL  
ADJUST menu opens, the internal noise test automatically  
begins.  
Note:  
Press the button to skip the internal noise test.  
During the internal noise test, it is possible to select an output level  
parameter just as the cursor is about to automatically scroll to the  
next parameter, causing the MC-12 to send the calibration noise  
signal to both speakers. If this occurs, reselect the desired speaker.  
During the internal noise test, the MC-12 sends calibration noise  
signals to each speaker in the order shown on the SPEAKER LEVEL  
ADJUST menu. The cursor automatically scrolls through output level  
parameters, highlighting each parameter as the MC-12 sends the  
calibration noise signal to the corresponding speaker. The  
calibration noise signal is sent to each speaker for about 4 seconds.  
3. When the horizontal bar graph opens, press the or ꢂ  
button to select the output level that achieves a 75dB SPL  
meter reading from the primary listening position.  
Note:  
4. Press to close the parameter. The internal noise test will  
continue and automatic scrolling will resume.  
When the internal noise test begins, the MC-12 automatically sets  
volume level to +0dB. Avoid adjusting the master volume level while  
the test is in progress to achieve THX reference levels (75dB).  
5. Repeat steps 2, 3, and 4 until all desired output levels have  
been set.  
INTERNAL NOISE TEST LEVELS CALIBRATION MANUAL SPEAKERS SETUP  
3-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup  
Lexicon  
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST  
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
Selecting the LEVELS CALIBRATION menu EXTERNAL NOISE TEST  
option opens the SPEAKER LEVEL ADJUST menu shown on page  
3-54, which manually calibrates output levels.  
Note:  
When the external noise test begins, the MC-12 automatically sets  
volume level to +0dB. Avoid adjusting the master volume level while  
the test is in progress to achieve THX reference levels (75dB).  
The external noise test requires an external calibration source such  
as an audio calibration disc. When the external noise test is  
conducted, the MC-12 activates a listening mode based on the  
current Main Zone input source. Refer to the table below for more  
information about external noise test listening mode activation.  
To manually calibrate output levels during the external noise test:  
1. Set the SPL Meter to “C” weighting and “SLOW” response.  
2. Place the SPL Meter at the primary listening position.  
When a listening mode is activated during the external noise test,  
all custom listening mode menu parameter settings are ignored.  
The listening mode is applied to the current Main Zone input  
source in its factory-default condition. When the external noise test  
is finished, the listening mode returns to its custom condition.  
3. Press the or arrow button to highlight the output level  
parameter you want. Then, press the button to select this  
output level parameter.  
The horizontal bar graph shown on page 3-54 displays.  
4. Begin playback of the external calibration source and press the  
or arrow button to select the output level that achieves a  
75dB SPL Meter reading.  
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST LEVELS CALIBRATION MANUAL SPEAKERS SETUP  
INPUT SOURCE  
LISTENING MODE  
5. After selecting the output level, press the arrow button to  
2-Channel  
PLII MOVIE,  
DIGITAL**  
PLIIx MOVIE*  
close the horizontal bar graph.  
Dolby Digital  
DTS(-ES)  
6. Repeat steps 2, 3, and 4 until you have set all the output levels  
you want.  
*
5.1-Channel Analog 5.1a STANDARD  
* These listening modes depend on the speaker configuration. Dolby Pro Logic IIx MOVIE  
will only load when side and rear speakers are present.  
**These listening mode names differ depending on the current input source, speaker  
setup, and parameter settings. Refer to the Listening Mode Descriptions section  
beginning on page 5-5 for more information.  
3-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Setup  
SETTING BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
The BASS PEAK LIMITERS option displays the BASS PEAK LIMITERS menu to set amplitude limits on low frequency signals sent to the Main Zone  
audio output Subwoofer L/R and LFE connectors. This menu also sets amplitude limits on low frequency signals redirected to other Main Zone  
audio output connectors. The MC-12 is equipped with an internal limiter to prevent low frequency signals from exceeding a designated output  
level. This is essential for Dolby Digital and DTS(-ES) sources that produce low frequency signal peaks at much higher output levels than  
2-channel sources. In home theaters, there is a danger of the subwoofers and their associated amplifiers overloading when attempting to  
reproduce low frequency signals.  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
INTERNAL NOISE TEST  
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
CAL NOISE  
L/R LIMITER  
L/R LIMIT ADJ  
LFE LIMITER  
LFE LIMIT ADJ  
ON  
ON  
100dB  
ON  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
R
SR  
RR  
0.0dB  
100dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
C
!CAUTION!  
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS  
0.0dB  
M
L
SL RL  
0.0dB  
SUB  
75 to 120dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
ON  
OFF  
Note:  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Setting  
You should configure BASS PEAK LIMITERS menu parameter settings  
whether output levels are automatically or manually calibrated.  
CAL NOISE  
L/R LIMITER  
ON  
ON  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
L/R LIMIT ADJ 100dB  
LFE LIMITER ON  
LFE LIMIT ADJ 100dB  
75 to 120dB  
ON, OFF  
75 to 120dB  
3-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Setup  
Lexicon  
CAL NOISE  
ON, OFF  
L/R LIMIT ADJ  
75 to 120dB  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
L/R LIMITER ADJ  
CAL NOISE  
Determines whether bass peak limiters are set with an internal or  
external calibration source.  
Specifies the output level restriction applied to the Subwoofer L/R  
output connectors, and to other Main Zone audio output  
connectors to which low frequency signals are redirected.  
To set the CAL NOISE parameter:  
To set the L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter:  
Select ON to activate an internal calibration noise signal to set  
bass peak limiters.  
1. Select the L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter.  
Select OFF to deactivate the internal calibration noise signal.  
The parameter initally sets to 75dB.  
Setting bass peak limiters with the calibration noise set to OFF  
requires an external calibration source such as an audio calibra-  
tion disc.  
2. Press the and arrow buttons to change the parameter  
value.  
The selected output level restriction is applied when the L/R  
LIMITER parameter is set to ON.  
L/R LIMITER  
ON, OFF  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
LFE LIMITER  
ON, OFF  
L/R LIMITER  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
Limits low frequency signals sent to the subwoofer or redirected to  
other speakers.  
LFE LIMITER  
Limits low frequency signals sent to the LFE subwoofer or redirected  
to other speakers.  
To set the L/R LIMITER parameter:  
Select ON to restrict the output level of the low frequency  
To set the LFE LIMITER parameter:  
signals to the L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter setting.  
Select ON to restrict the output level of the low frequency  
Select OFF to allow an unrestricted signal output level, regard-  
less of the L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter setting.  
signals to the LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter setting.  
Select OFF to allow an unrestricted signal output level, regard-  
less of the LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter setting.  
3-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
MC-12  
Setup  
To set the LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter:  
LFE LIMITER ADJ  
75 to 120dB  
SETUP  
SPEAKERS  
MANUAL  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
1. Select the LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter.  
LFE LIMITER ADJ  
The parameter initally sets to 75dB.  
Specifies the output level restriction the MC-12 applies to the LFE  
output connector.  
2. Press the and arrow buttons to change the parameter  
value.  
The selected output level restriction is applied when the LFE  
LIMITER parameter is set to ON.  
REAR-PANEL CONFIGURATION  
8 STEREO INPUTS  
SETUP  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
SETUP  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
8 STEREO INPUTS  
Selecting the REAR PANEL CONFIG option displays the REAR PANEL  
CONFIG menu shown below, to configure the analog audio input  
connectors as eight (Left/Right) stereo connectors or as five  
(Left/Right) stereo connectors and one 5.1-channel configuration  
(Front L/R, Center, Subwoofer, Side L/R)  
Select the 8 STEREO INPUTS option to configure the analog audio  
input connectors as eight stereo connectors.  
When 8 STEREO INPUTS is selected:  
All analog audio input connectors are configured as stereo  
connectors.  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
8 STEREO INPUTS  
OR  
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
The 5.1-channel connector is not available.  
Input sources that were assigned to the 5.1-channel connector  
are reassigned to the stereo connector labeled 6.  
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG  
FOR REAR PANEL CFG  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
8 STEREO INPUTS  
FOR REAR PANEL CFG  
3-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup  
Lexicon  
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG  
SETUP  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG  
Select the 5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG option to configure the analog audio  
input connectors as five stereo and one 5.1-channel connectors.  
The 5.1-channel input is sent to the Main Zone audio output  
connectors as indicated in the table below.  
When 5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG is selected:  
Input Connector(s)  
Output Connector(s)  
The 5.1-channel connector should only be used with  
5.1-channel analog sources such as DVD-As and SACDs.  
(L) & (R)  
(C)  
Front L/R  
Center  
The analog audio input connectors labeled 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 are  
configured as stereo connectors.  
(SUB)  
Subwoofer L/R & LFE  
The analog audio input connectors labeled 6, 7, and 8 are  
configured as 5.1-channel connectors.  
(LS) & (RS) 5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG Side L/R & Rear L/R  
8 STEREO INPUTS REAR PANEL CONFIG SETUP  
Input sources that were assigned to the stereo connectors  
labeled 6, 7, and 8 are reassigned to conform to the  
5.1-channel configuration.  
3-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Setup  
DISPLAY SETUP  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
The DISPLAYS option displays the DISPLAY SETUP menu, to customize the on-screen and front-panel displays, restore audio/video synchroni-  
zation, and create and activate a custom unit name.  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
DISPLAY SETUP  
OFF, 1 to 60ms  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
CUSTOM NAME  
ON, OFF  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Setting  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
CUSTOM  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
Activates the display of the custom unit name, which can be  
created with the EDIT CUSTOM NAME menu. When ON is selected,  
the custom unit name scrolls across the on-screen and front panel  
displays whenever the MC-12 is activated. When OFF is selected,  
the custom unit name does not scroll across the on-screen and  
front- panel displays when the MC-12 is activated.  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY Refer to page 3-65  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF, 1 to 60ms  
ON, OFF  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME Refer to page 3-62  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
OFF, 1 to 60ms  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
Restores audio/video synchronization when the MC-12 is  
connected to components such as video processors that introduce  
video signal delays. Select a value between 1 and 60ms to activate  
an audio signal delay to compensate for the video signal delay.  
3-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Setup  
Lexicon  
DISPLAY SETUP (continued)  
MAIN MENU  
DISPLAY SETUP  
SETUP  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
MC-12  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
OFF  
OFF  
BUTTONS TO EDIT  
UP TO 20 CHARACTERS  
BUTTON TO ADVANCE  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
Opens the EDIT CUSTOM NAME drop-down menu shown above,  
which can be used to create a custom unit name. The factory  
default unit name is MC-12.  
Pressing will close the EDIT CUSTOM NAME drop-down  
menu.  
4. When the desired custom unit name has been entered,  
press until the EDIT CUSTOM NAME menu closes.  
To create a custom unit name:  
1. Follow the EDIT CUSTOM NAME menu path shown above to  
open the EDIT CUSTOM NAME drop-down menu.  
2. When the EDIT CUSTOM NAME menu drops down, locate the  
current unit name on the second line. The cursor automatically  
appears beneath the first character in the current unit name.  
3. Use the following remote control commands to enter a unit  
name:  
Press the or arrow button to change the character  
above the cursor.  
Press the button to advance to the next character space.  
The cursor will automatically wrap to the first character  
space when the last (twentieth) character space is passed.  
3-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Setup  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
The ON-SCREEN DISPLAY option opens the ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu, to customize the on-screen display.  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
DISPLAY SETUP  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
ALWAYS ON  
2 SECONDS  
ALWAYS OFF  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
STATUS  
2 SECONDS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
POSITION  
FORMAT  
BACKGROUND  
REMOTE STATE  
TOP  
NTSC  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
TOP  
CENTER  
BOTTOM  
ON  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SECAM  
PAL  
ON  
OFF  
NTSC  
for two seconds whenever a new input source is present or a new  
command is received. When ALWAYS OFF is selected, the on-screen  
display remains deactivated at all times, and will not reactivate until the  
STATUS parameter is set to ALWAYS ON or 2 SECONDS.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
STATUS  
2 SECONDS  
ALWAYS ON, 2 SEC-  
ONDS, ALWAYS OFF  
TOP, CENTER, BOTTOM  
SECAM,PAL, NTSC  
ON, OFF  
Note:  
POSITION  
TOP  
NTSC  
ON  
FORMAT  
When the ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu STATUS parameter is set to  
ALWAYS OFF, the on-screen display immediately deactivates. Press the  
OSD button or use the front-panel display as a guide to reset the  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu STATUS parameter to ALWAYS ON or 2  
SECONDS.  
BACKGROUND  
REMOTE STATE  
ON  
ON, OFF  
STATUS  
ALWAYS ON, 2 SECONDS, ALWAYS OFF  
POSITION  
TOP, CENTER, BOTTOM  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
STATUS  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
POSITION  
Controls the activation of the on-screen display when the display  
device is connected to a Main Zone video output connector. When  
ALWAYS ON is selected, the on-screen display remains activated at all  
times. When 2 SECONDS is selected, the on-screen display activates  
Controls the vertical alignment of the two-line status on the display  
device screen. When TOP is selected, the two-line status appears  
near the top of the display device screen. When CENTER is selected,  
3-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Setup  
Lexicon  
the two-line status appears centered on the display device screen.  
When BOTTOM is selected, the two-line status appears near the  
bottom of the display device screen.  
Note:  
When the BACKGROUND parameter is set to OFF, the on-screen  
display automatically deactivates when the display device is connected  
to the Main Zone component video output connector.  
FORMAT  
SECAM, PAL, NTSC  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
FORMAT  
REMOTE STATE  
ON, OFF  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
REMOTE STATE  
Controls the compatibility between the composite and S-video  
output connectors, the video switcher, and the display device.  
Select the setting that is compatible with the source components  
and the display device.  
Activates the remote control command bank indicator, a letter that  
appears in the top-right corner of the on-screen display to indicate  
the command bank from which the MC-12 last received a  
command. The table below indicates the letter that represents each  
command bank.  
Note:  
The FORMAT parameter has no effect on the component video output  
connector.  
When ON is selected, the command bank indicator appears in the  
top-right corner of the on-screen display whenever the MC-12  
receives a remote control command. When OFF is selected, the  
command bank indicator does not appear on the on-screen display  
when the MC-12 receives a remote control command.  
BACKGROUND  
ON, OFF  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
BACKGROUND  
Determines the on-screen display background. When ON is  
selected, the on-screen display appears over a solid blue or gray  
background (depending on the display device). When OFF is  
selected, the on-screen display appears over the video input signal.  
Letter Indicator  
Command Bank  
None*  
Main Zone  
Zone 2  
Z
R
S
Record Zone  
Shift  
* No letter appears when the MC-12 receives a command from the Main Zone com-  
mand bank, even if the REMOTE STATE parameter is set to ON.  
3-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Setup  
FRONT-PANEL DISPLAY  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
Opens the FRONT PANEL DISPLAY menu, to customize the front panel display.  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
DISPLAY SETUP  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
ALWAYS ON  
2 SECONDS  
ALWAYS OFF  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
STATUS  
ALWAYS ON  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
BRIGHTNESS  
100%  
OFF  
OFF  
100%  
75%  
50%  
25%  
DISPLAY DISPLAYS SETUP  
BRIGHTNESS  
100%, 75%, 50%, 25%  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
BRIGHTNESS  
STATUS  
ALWAYS ON ALWAYS ON, 2 SECONDS,  
ALWAYS OFF  
Controls the illumination of front-panel display characters. When a  
setting is selected, front-panel display characters automatically  
adjust to the selected illumination percentage.  
BRIGHTNESS 100%  
100%, 75%, 50%, 25%  
STATUS  
ALWAYS ON, 2 SECONDS, ALWAYS OFF  
SETUP  
DISPLAYS  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
STATUS  
Controls the activation of the front-panel display. When ALWAYS ON  
is selected, the front-panel display remains activated at all times.  
When 2 SECONDS is selected, the front-panel display activates for  
two seconds whenever a new input source is present or a new  
command is received. When ALWAYS OFF is selected, the front-panel  
display remains deactivated at all times, and will not reactivate until  
the STATUS parameter is reset to ALWAYS ON or 2 SECONDS.  
3-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup  
Lexicon  
VOLUME-CONTROL SETUP  
SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
Opens the VOLUME CONTROL SETUP menu, to configure the Main  
Zone, Zone 2, and Record Zone volume levels.  
level to the selected value when the Main Zone is activated. When  
LAST LVL is selected, the MC-12 sets Main Zone volume level to the  
last volume level that was selected in the Main Zone during the  
previous operating session.  
SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROL SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
MAIN PWR ON  
MUTE LEVEL  
ZONE PWR ON  
REC PWR ON  
MAX VOLUME  
-30dB  
-30dB  
-30dB  
-30dB  
+12dB  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MUTE LEVEL  
-10dB, -20dB, -30dB, -40dB, FULL MUTE  
SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
MUTE LEVEL  
Determines the amount of attenuation that occurs in the Main  
Zone when the Mute button is pressed. When a value is selected,  
Main Zone volume level is attenuated to the selected value when  
the Mute button is pressed. When FULL MUTE is selected, Main  
Zone volume level is fully attenuated when the Mute button is  
pressed.  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB  
-10dB  
-20dB  
-30dB  
-40dB  
FULL MUTE  
ZONE PWR ON  
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB  
VOLUME CONTROLS SETUP  
SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
ZONE PWR ON  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Setting  
MAIN PWR ON -30dB  
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB  
Selects the volume level at which Zone 2 activates. When a value is  
selected, the MC-12 automatically sets Zone 2 volume level to the  
selected value when Zone 2 is activated. When LAST LVL is selected,  
the MC-12 sets Zone 2 volume level to the last volume level that  
was selected in Zone 2 during the previous operating session.  
MUTE LEVEL  
-30dB  
-10dB, -20dB, -30dB, -40dB,  
FULL MUTE  
ZONE PWR ON -30dB  
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB  
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB  
-80 to +12dB  
REC PWR ON  
MAX VOLUME  
-30dB  
+12dB  
REC PWR ON  
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB  
SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
REC PWR ON  
MAIN PWR ON  
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB  
Selects the volume level at which the Record Zone activates. When  
a value is selected, the MC-12 automatically sets Record Zone  
volume level to the selected value when the Record Zone is  
activated. When LAST LVL is selected, the MC-12 sets Record Zone  
SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
MAIN PWR ON  
Selects the volume level at which the Main Zone activates. When a  
value is selected, the MC-12 automatically sets Main Zone volume  
3-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MC-12  
Setup  
volume level to the last volume level that was selected in the Record  
Zone during the previous operating session.  
MAX VOLUME  
-80 to +12dB  
SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
MAX VOLUME  
Selects the maximum volume level for the Main Zone. When a  
value is selected, the MC-12 automatically sets Main Zone volume  
level to the selected value.  
3-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setup  
Lexicon  
TRIGGER SETUP  
TRIGGER SETUP  
TRIGGER SETUP  
REMOTE ONLY  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VC  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
ZONE2 INPUTS  
RECORD INPUTS  
FILM  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
5.1 MONO SURR  
5.1 MONO  
FILM  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
SETUP  
TRIGGERS  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
SETUP  
TRIGGER SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
2-CHAN  
5.1a FILM  
5.1a MUSIC  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
TRIGGER 1  
TRIGGER 2  
REMOTE  
REMOTE  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
5.1a  
5.1a  
SurEX  
MUSIC  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
5.1a BYPASS  
2CH BYPASS  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
TV  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
PLIIx +  
PLIIx MOV  
PLIIx MUS  
PLII +  
PLII MOVIE  
PLII MUSIC  
PL +  
PRO LOGIC  
+
LIVE! LARGE  
The TRIGGERS option prompts you to select trigger output connector 1 or 2. The MC-12  
includes three 12V DC trigger output connectors labeled PWR (power), 1, and 2. The PWR  
connector cannot be configured because its trigger output connector is activated and  
deactivated when the MC-12 is activated and deactivated or placed into standby. The other  
connectors can be configured for remote or program operation.  
CIN  
MUSIC  
NIGHTCLUB  
CONCERT HHALL  
CHURCH  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
2-CH SURROUND  
2-CHANNEL  
MONO LOGIC  
MONO SURROUND  
MONO  
Selecting TRIGGER 1 or TRIGGER 2 displays the corresponding TRIGGER SETUP menu, to  
configure the selected trigger output connector. The TRIGGER SETUP menu shown at the  
right is used as an example. The parameters on the left side of the TRIGGER SETUP menus  
are identical regardless of whether TRIGGER 1 or TRIGGER 2 is selected. The parameter  
settings on the right side are adjustable. The TRIGGER SETUP menu indicates factory  
default parameter settings for both connectors.  
5.1 FILM  
5.1 TV  
5.1 MUSIC  
MUSIC  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
DIGITAL EX  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
REMOTE ONLY  
ON  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
Program Operation  
OFF  
All TRIGGER SETUP menu parameters – except the REMOTE ONLY parameter – are considered program operation parameters.  
ON  
OFF  
3-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Setup  
TRIGGER SETUP (continued)  
Note the following:  
REMOTE ONLY  
ON, OFF  
OR  
TRIGGER 1  
SETUP  
TRIGGER 2  
REMOTE ONLY  
TRIGGERS  
Connectors can be associated with individual Main Zone inputs  
and listening modes, as well as the Zone 2 and Record Zone  
inputs.  
Configures the selected trigger output connector for remote  
operation. Select the ON setting to configure the selected  
connector for remote operation. Select the OFF setting to configure  
the selected connector for program operation. Refer to the Program  
Operation Parameter description below for more information.  
Connectors cannot be associated with individual Zone 2 and  
Record Zone inputs.  
Connectors can be associated with multiple inputs and  
listening modes at the same time.  
When configured for remote operation, the connector labeled 1  
can be activated and deactivated with the MODE + and – buttons  
when the Zone 2 command bank is activated, and the connector  
labeled 2 can be activated and deactivated with the MODE + and –  
buttons when the Record Zone command bank is activated.  
Note:  
When the CUSTOM menu RESET MODE option is selected to restore  
the factory-default version of the selected listening mode, the  
corresponding TRIGGER SETUP menu program operation parameter is  
automatically set to OFF.  
Note:  
When the REMOTE ONLY parameter is set to ON, all TRIGGER SETUP  
menu program operation parameter settings are ignored.  
PROGRAM OPERATION PARAMETERS  
ON, OFF  
OR  
SETUP  
TRIGGERS  
TRIGGER 1  
TRIGGER 2  
Program Operation Parameter  
Configures the selected trigger output connector for program  
operation when the REMOTE ONLY parameter is set to OFF. Select  
the ON setting to associate the selected connector with the corre-  
sponding input(s) or listening mode(s).  
When configured for program operation, the connector is activated  
and deactivated when the associated inputs or listening modes are  
activated and deactivated.  
3-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
LOCK OPTIONS  
SETUP  
LOCK OPTIONS  
Displays the LOCK OPTIONS menu, which protects MODE ADJUST,  
AUDIO CONTROLS, and SETUP menu branch parameter settings  
from accidental changes.  
AUDIO CNTRL  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
SETUP  
LOCK OPTIONS  
AUDIO CNTRL  
Protects AUDIO CONTROLS menu branch settings from accidental  
changes. When LOCKED is selected, AUDIO CONTROLS menu  
branch settings cannot be adjusted. When UNLOCKED is selected,  
AUDIO CONTROLS menu branch settings can be adjusted.  
LOCK OPTIONS  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
UNLOCKED  
UNLOCKED  
UNLOCKED  
SETUP  
AUDIO CNTRL  
MODES  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SETUP  
SETUP  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
LOCKED  
UNLOCKED  
LOCK OPTIONS  
SETUP  
Protects SETUP menu branch settings from accidental changes.  
When LOCKED is selected, SETUP menu branch settings cannot be  
adjusted. When UNLOCKED is selected, SETUP menu branch  
settings can be adjusted.  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
MODES  
UNLOCKED  
UNLOCKED  
UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
AUDIO CNTRL  
SETUP  
Note the following:  
When the MODES parameter is set to LOCKED, the up and  
down arrows can still be used to adjust subwoofer output levels  
applied to the selected listening mode when the Shift  
command bank is activated.  
MODES  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
SETUP  
LOCK OPTIONS  
MODES  
When the SETUP parameter is set to LOCKED, the 2CH button  
can still be used to adjust the MAIN ADV menu ANALOG  
BYPASS parameter setting when the Shift command bank is  
activated.  
Protects MODE ADJUST menu branch settings from accidental  
changes. When LOCKED is selected, MODE ADJUST menu branch  
settings – including all listening mode menu settings – cannot be  
adjusted. When UNLOCKED is selected, all MODE ADJUST menu  
branch settings can be adjusted.  
When the SETUP parameter is set to LOCKED, the 7/5 button  
can still be used to adjust the MAIN ADV menu INPUT SELECT  
parameter setting when the Shift command bank is activated.  
3-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
MC-12  
Setup  
The location of the sound source (piano, guitar, voices, etc.) is not  
critical. LIVE! will compensate for sounds that are closer to one micro-  
phone or another.  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SETUP  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
LIVE! (Lexicon Intelligent Variable Environment) is a proprietary mode  
designed to transform the way your listening room sounds. LIVE! uses  
a combination of microphones and digital signal processing (DSP) to  
enhance the room acoustics and create the illusion of a larger, more  
reverberant listening space. Use LIVE! to create a pleasing environment  
to practice or perform with a musical instrument, or to create a livelier  
ambience for any social activity. LIVE! CALIBRATION must be  
completed before using any of the LIVE! modes.  
CONNECTING THE MICROPHONES  
MC-12 Rear Panel  
Notes:  
CAUTION!  
You should run automatic calibration before running LIVE! CALIBRATION.  
See page 3-35 for instructions on running an automatic calibration.  
The Lexicon microphones require careful handling. Dropping  
or otherwise physically abusing the microphones can cause  
calibration errors or irreparable damage to the microphone.  
Any changes to the LEVELS CALIBRATION or CROSSOVER SETUP in the  
SPEAKER SETUP menu will cause LIVE! to become uncalibrated.  
The microphone wires also require careful handling. Do not  
sharply bend the wires or place objects on them.  
Pressing the remote control 7/5 button will cause LIVE! to become uncalibrated.  
1. Make sure the MC-12 is powered off or in standby mode.  
LIVE! requires 2 microphones, available in a kit from your authorized  
Lexicon dealer. (If you already own the Lexicon 4-microphone kit,  
there is no need to purchase the 2-microphone kit) These microphones  
should be permanently mounted in the listening room. Performing  
LIVE! CALIBRATION with any microphones other than those in the kit  
can produce undesirable results.  
2. Connect the Lexicon microphones to the microphone input 1 and  
2 connectors on the MC-12 rear panel shown above. Connector 1  
is for the left microphone, connector 2 is for the right. Microphones  
connected to inputs 3 and 4 will be ignored during LIVE! calibration  
and operation. Make sure each microphone cable plug is fully  
inserted for a solid connection.  
To achieve the proper LIVE! effect your system should be configured  
with a minimum of 4 speakers (Front L/R, and either side L/R or Rear  
L/R). If no subwoofer is present, the crossover setting of the Front L/R  
speakers should be set to FULL.  
During the microphone check, the microphones will be  
referred to as 1 and 2 based on the input connector to which  
the microphone is connected. You should label the micro-  
phones for troubleshooting purposes.  
Proper microphone placement, both during calibration and when  
running LIVE!, is essential to achieving the desired results. Suggested  
microphone placement instructions and illustrations are included in  
this section.  
3. Power on the MC-12 or deactivate standby mode.  
3-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setup  
Lexicon  
POSITIONING THE MICROPHONES FOR LIVE!  
Refer to the microphone placement examples below to position the microphones for LIVE!  
PROPER  
microphone positioning for LIVE!  
Position the microphones:  
3 On or near opposite side walls  
3 Approximately halfway between the front and  
side speakers  
Rear  
Left  
3 At an approximate height between the waist  
Side  
Left  
and head of a standing person  
Rear  
Right  
3 In a location unobstructed by furniture and  
other fixtures  
3 At least 2 feet (0.61m) from all speakers.  
Side  
Right  
Note:  
LIVE! can potentially create feedback in the system.  
The processing is designed to prevent this, but you  
should avoid placing the microphones too close to  
speakers.  
Front  
Left  
Microphone  
Center  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
proper microphone placement during LIVE! calibration  
and also for permanent location.  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Setup  
IMPROPER  
microphone positioning for LIVE!  
When positioning the microphones, do  
not:  
7 Place the microphones on the front or rear walls  
7 Place the microphones near the floor or ceiling  
Rear  
Left  
7 Obstruct the microphones with furniture or other  
fixtures  
Side  
Left  
Rear  
7 Place the microphones within 2 feet (0.61m) of  
Right  
any speaker.  
The illustration to the right provides an example of  
improper microphone placement for LIVE! calibration  
or for a permanent location.  
Side  
Right  
Front  
Left  
Center  
Microphone  
Subwoofer  
Front  
Right  
3-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setup  
Lexicon  
PERFORMING LIVE! CALIBRATION  
L
I
V
E!  
!CA  
HIGH AU  
YOU WILL E 10 SEC  
TO LEAVE  
SIT QU  
PRESS
C
A
LI  
TI  
IOLEVELS  
R
ATION  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
IN PROGRESS  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
U
O
N!  
TEST WILL BEGIN IN  
10  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
D
CALIBRATION DONE  
T  
H
A
V
PRESS TO SKIP  
COUNTDOWN  
HE  
R
OOM OR  
PLEASE WAIT  
I
E
TLY  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
PRESS TO CONTINUE  
T
O
BEGIN  
COUNTDOWN  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SIGNAL TOO LOW  
PRESS TO CONTINUE  
Select SETUP LIVE! CALIBRATION as shown above.  
The !CAUTION! HIGH AUDIO LEVELS message indicates that the MC-  
12 generates loud calibration noise signals during LIVE! calibration. If  
the signals become too loud, press the arrow button to cancel  
LIVE! calibration. Press the arrow button to begin calibration.  
SIGNAL TOO LOW  
Indicates that the microphones failed to pick up sufficient cali-  
bration noise signals for calibration to complete.  
The countdown display notifies you that LIVE! calibration begins in  
10 seconds. The primary reason for the 10 second delay is to give  
you time to leave the listening space before automatic calibration  
begins. If you choose to remain in the room, your movements  
could affect the calibration results. If you leave the room, you can  
return in about 3 minutes (the calibration procedure should be  
completed). Press the arrow button to skip the countdown  
and begin LIVE! calibration. The MC-12 automatically activates  
LIVE! calibration when the countdown ends.  
After reading the message, press to continue.  
If the SIGNAL TOO LOW message appeared:  
Examine microphone input connections to ensure that the  
microphones are properly connected to the MC-12 in  
microphone inputs 1 and 2 and that microphone cable plugs  
are fully inserted for a solid connection.  
Examine the speakers and the associated amplifier to ensure  
that speaker wires are connected and the amplifier is on.  
When the LIVE! calibration is finished, the LIVE CALIBRATION results  
screen displays one of the two following messages.  
Run a Microphone Check to determine if a microphone has  
been damaged. See page 3-39 for instructions on checking the  
microphones.  
CALIBRATION DONE  
Indicates that no errors occurred during the calibration procedure.  
3-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Audio Controls  
Audio Controls............................................................................4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Audio Controls  
Lexicon  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
Selecting the MAIN MENU AUDIO CONTROLS option opens the AUDIO CONTROLS menu, to customize the Main Zone, Zone 2, and Record  
Zone audio output connectors.  
MAIN MENU  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
BASS  
TREBLE  
TILT EQ  
LOUDNESS  
BALANCE  
FADER  
+0.0dB  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
OFF  
<I>  
<I>  
ZONE2 BALANCE  
RECORD BALANCE <I>  
<I>  
ON  
OFF  
-3.0 to +3.0dB  
-6.0 to +6.0dB  
L<  
<L>  
>R  
B<  
<L>  
>F  
Default Setting  
The BASS, TREBLE, TILT EQ, LOUDNESS, BALANCE, and FADER  
parameters affect the Main Zone audio output connectors. This  
includes all Main Zone inputs and listening modes, except the  
5.1a BYPASS and 2CH BYPASS listening modes.  
Parameter  
Possible Settings  
BASS  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
OFF  
-6.0 to +6.0dB  
-6.0 to +6.0dB  
-3.0 to +3.0dB  
ON, OFF  
TREBLE  
The ZONE2 BALANCE parameter affects the Zone 2 audio  
output connectors, including all Zone 2 inputs.  
TILT EQ  
LOUDNESS  
BALANCE  
FADER  
The REC BALANCE parameter affects the Record Zone audio  
output connectors, including all Record Zone inputs.  
<|>  
L< to <|> to >R  
B< to <|> to >F  
L< to <|> to >R  
B< to <|> to >F  
<|>  
ZONE2 BALANCE <|>  
REC BALANCE <|>  
AUDIO CONTROLS menu parameter descriptions begin on the next page.  
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
MC-12  
Audio Controls  
BASS  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
-6.0dB to +6.0dB  
BASS  
BASS  
Controls the amount of low-frequency boost or cut applied to the  
Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE,  
and Subwoofer L/R. The graph to the right indicates the frequency  
response of all BASS parameter settings.  
To control the bass from the remote control:  
Press the Shift button:  
Press the CD button to increase the BASS parameter setting in  
0.5dB increments.  
Press the TAPE button to decrease the BASS parameter setting  
in 0.5dB increments.  
Press the OSD button to set the BASS, TREBLE, and TILT EQ  
parameters to +0.0dB.  
The BASS parameter controls the amount of low-frequency boost or cut applied to the  
Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, and Subwoofer L/R.  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Audio Controls  
Lexicon  
TREBLE  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
-6.0dB to +6.0dB  
TREBLE  
TREBLE  
Controls the amount of boost or cut applied to the Main Zone  
audio output connectors labeled Front L/R and Center. The graph  
shown at the right indicates the frequency response of all TREBLE  
parameter settings.  
To control the treble from the remote control:  
Press the Shift button:  
Press the PVR button to increase the TREBLE parameter setting  
in 0.5dB increments.  
Press the TUNER button to decrease the TREBLE parameter  
setting in 0.5dB increments.  
Press the OSD button to set the BASS, TREBLE, and TILT EQ  
parameters to +0.0dB.  
The TREBLE parameter controls the amount of boost or cut applied to the Main  
Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R and Center.  
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Audio Controls  
TILT EQ  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
-3.0 to +3.0  
TILT EQ  
TILT EQ  
Controls the amount of tilt equalization applied to the Main Zone  
audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, and  
Subwoofer L/R. This parameter setting affects the entire frequency  
spectrum with a hinge point at 1kHz. As the setting increases,  
frequencies higher than 1kHz are boosted while frequencies lower  
than 1kHz are simultaneously cut. As the setting decreases,  
frequencies higher than 1kHz are cut while frequencies lower than  
1kHz are simultaneously boosted. The graph shown at the right  
indicates the frequency response of all TILT EQ parameter settings.  
To control the tilt EQ from the remote control:  
Press the Shift button:  
Press the GAME button to increase the TILT EQ parameter  
setting in 0.5dB increments.  
Press the AUX button to decrease the TILT EQ parameter setting  
in 0.5dB increments.  
Press the OSD button to set the BASS, TREBLE, and TILT EQ  
parameters to +0.0dB.  
The TILT EQ parameter controls the amount of tilt equalization applied to the Main  
Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R, Center, LFE, and Subwoofer L/R.  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Audio Controls  
Lexicon  
LOUDNESS  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
ON, OFF  
LOUDNESS  
LOUDNESS  
Controls the amount of low-frequency boost that is automatically  
applied to the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front  
L/R, Center, LFE, and Subwoofer L/R. When ON is selected,  
loudness compensation is automatically applied based on volume  
level. As volume level increases, the amount of low-frequency boost  
automatically decreases. The loudness contour is optimized for  
input sources calibrated to THX reference levels. When OFF is  
selected, no loudness compensation is applied.  
The graph shown at the right indicates the frequency response that  
is automatically applied when the LOUDNESS parameter is set to  
ON and Main Zone volume level is adjusted.  
To control the loudness from the remote control:  
Press the Shift button:  
Press the TV button to turn the LOUDNESS to on.  
Press the SAT button to turn the LOUDNESS off.  
The LOUDNESS parameter controls the amount of low-frequency boost that is  
automatically applied to the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front  
L/R, Center, LFE, and Subwoofer L/R.  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Audio Controls  
BALANCE  
L< <|> >R  
ZONE2 BALANCE  
L< <|> >R  
BALANCE  
ZONE2 BALANCE  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
Controls the left-to-right balance of the Main Zone audio output  
connectors labeled Front L/R.  
Controls the left-to-right balance of the Zone 2 audio output  
connectors.  
To control the balance from the remote control:  
To control the Zone 2 balance from the remote control:  
Press the Shift button:  
Press the ZONE button:  
Press the MENU button to center the Main Zone balance.  
Press the MENU button to center the Zone2 balance.  
Press the or arrow buttons to adjust the Main Zone  
balance left and right.  
Press the or arrow buttons to adjust the Zone2 balance  
left and right.  
FADER  
B< <|> >F  
RECORD BALANCE  
L< <|> >R  
FADER  
RECORD BALANCE  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
Controls the front-to-back balance of the Main Zone audio output  
connectors labeled Front L/R.  
Controls the left-to-right balance of the Record Zone analog audio  
output connectors.  
To control the fade from the remote control:  
To control the balance from the remote control:  
Press the Shift button:  
Press the REC button:  
Press the MENU button to center the Main Zone fader.  
Press the MENU button to center the Main Zone balance.  
Press the or arrow buttons to adjust the Main Zone fader  
backward and forward.  
Press the or arrow buttons to adjust the record balance  
left and right.  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
Mode Adjust  
Mode Adjust ...............................................................................5-2  
Listening Mode Activation...........................................................5-2  
Preferred Listening Mode Selection Parameters ........................................ 5-3  
Mode Buttons .......................................................................................... 5-4  
Mode Family Selection Buttons ................................................................ 5-4  
Listening Mode Descriptions .......................................................5-5  
Listening Mode Menu Option & Parameter Descriptions...........5-37  
Mode – Parameter Relationships ...............................................5-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
MODE ADJUST  
MAIN MENU  
MODE ADJUST  
MODE ADJUST  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
FILM  
TV  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
FILM  
MUSIC  
*
Selecting MAIN MENUMODE ADJUST displays the MODE ADJUST  
menu, to select a listening mode. Selecting a listening mode opens the  
corresponding listening mode menu, to customize the selected  
listening mode. These adjustments are applied when the listening  
mode is next activated.  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
PLIIx +  
PLIIx MOV  
PLIIx MUS  
PLII +  
PLII MOVIE  
PLII MUSIC  
PL +  
MUSIC  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
5.1a BYPASS  
2CH BYPASS  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
All listening mode menus are shown in the Appendix. The parameters  
on the left side of the menus differ from listening mode to listening  
mode. The parameter settings on the right side are adjustable.  
Factory-default parameter settings are shown for each listening mode.  
LIVE! LARGE  
PRO LOGIC  
+
CIN  
MUSIC  
NIGHTCLUB  
CONCERT HALL  
CHURCH  
When the MODE ADJUST menu opens, the activated listening mode is  
highlighted. To activate a different listening mode, you must use one  
of the methods described in “Listening Mode Activation” below.  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
2-CH SURROUND  
2-CHANNEL  
MONO LOGIC  
MONO SURROUND  
MONO  
LISTENING MODE ACTIVATION  
The MC-12 allows listening mode activation in the Main Zone.  
Listening modes are available for 2-channel, Dolby Digital, DTS-ES,  
analog, and microphone sources. In some cases, the MC-12 automati-  
cally activates a listening mode in response to certain commands. For  
this reason, it is important to understand the three methods through  
which listening mode activation occurs.  
5.1  
5.1  
5.1  
FILM  
TV  
MUSIC  
*
MUSIC  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
DIGITAL*  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
5.1 MONO SURR  
5.1 MONO  
Listening modes activation occurs through:  
The INPUT SETUP menu preferred listening mode selection  
parameters.  
* These listening mode  
names differ depend-  
ing on the current  
input source, speaker  
setup, and parame-  
ter settings. Refer to  
the Listening Mode  
Descriptions begin-  
ning on page 5-5 for  
more information.  
FILM*  
MUSIC*  
*
The front panel or remote control Mode and buttons.  
The remote control mode family selection buttons (THX, Dolby  
Digital, LOGIC 7, TVL, DTS, and MUSIC).  
MUSIC  
*
2-CHAN*  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
PREFERRED LISTENING MODE SELECTION  
PARAMETERS  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
CD INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
DVD1  
COAX-1  
NONE  
NAME  
CD  
COAX-4  
NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-1  
COMPONENT IN  
You can select five preferred listening modes for each Main Zone  
input, including one listening mode each for 2-channel, Dolby  
Digital, DTS-ES, 5.1-channel analog, and microphone sources. The  
table below indicates the INPUT SETUP menu parameters that can  
be used to select preferred listening modes.  
AUTO  
AUTO  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
1
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
FILM  
2-CH  
FILM  
FILM  
FILM  
2-CH  
D
5.1  
5.1a  
D
5.1  
5.1a  
MIC  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! MED  
Preferred Listening Mode Selection Parameters  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
2-CH  
Selects a preferred listening mode for 2-channel  
sources  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD ADVANCED  
D
Selects a preferred listening mode for Dolby Digital  
sources  
If the DVD1 input is selected while a 2-channel source is  
present, the MC-12 automatically activates the L7 FILM  
listening mode. If a 5.1-channel analog source becomes  
present, the MC-12 automatically activates the 5.1a L7 FILM  
listening mode.  
Selects a preferred listening mode for DTS-ES  
sources  
5.1a  
MIC  
Selects a preferred listening mode for 5.1-channel  
analog sources  
If the CD input is selected while a Dolby Digital source is  
present, the MC-12 automatically activates the 5.1 L7 MUSIC  
listening mode. If the DVD1 input is then selected while a  
DTS-ES source is present, the MC-12 automatically activates  
the DTS or DTS-ES L7 FILM listening mode.  
Selects a preferred LIVE! listening mode for micro-  
phone sources.  
When a preferred listening mode is selected, the MC-12 automati-  
cally activates that listening mode whenever a new input is selected  
or an appropriate input source is present. For example, the DVD1  
and CD INPUT SETUP menu preferred listening mode selection  
parameters are set as shown at the top of the next column.  
Note:  
Refer to the Selecting Preferred Listening Modes section that begins on  
page 3-12 for more information.  
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
MODE BUTTONS  
MODE FAMILY SELECTION BUTTONS  
Use the front panel and remote control Mode buttons to audition  
listening modes with the current Main Zone input source. Press the  
Mode + or button to scroll up or down through the available  
listening modes for the current Main Zone input source. For  
example, if a 2-channel source is present in the Main Zone, the  
Mode buttons can be used to audition 2-channel listening modes.  
The remote control mode family selection buttons select a listening  
mode within the corresponding mode family. Pressing a mode  
family selection button activates the most appropriate listening  
mode for the current Main Zone input source. For example,  
pressing the L7 button while a 2-channel source is present in the  
Main Zone activates the L7 FILM listening mode.  
Scrolling occurs in the order shown on the MODE ADJUST menu.  
The selected listening mode appears in the bottom-left corner of  
the Main Zone two-line status. The selected listening mode is  
automatically activated when scrolling stops.  
The table below indicates the listening modes associated with each  
mode family selection button.  
Input Source  
2-Channel  
5.1 Dolby Digital  
DTS-ES  
5.1a Channel Analog  
Button  
DOLBY PLIIx + THX†  
THX*  
Dolby DIGITAL*  
5.1 L7 FILM  
5.1 L7 TV  
DTS-ES THX*  
5.1a THX*  
DOLBY PLIIx MOVIE†  
L7 FILM  
N/A**  
DTS-ES L7 FILM*  
N/A**  
N/A**  
5.1a L7 FILM  
N/A**  
L7 TV  
DTS Neo:6 CIN††  
L7 MUSIC  
N/A**  
DTS-ES*  
N/A**  
5.1 L7 MUSIC  
DTS-ES L7 MUSIC*  
5.1a L7 MUSIC  
*
These listening mode names differ depending on the current input source, speaker setup, and parameter settings. Refer to the Listening Mode Descriptions section that begins on the  
next page for more information.  
** The MODE SELECTION NOT AVAILABLE message appears on the on-screen and front panel displays when the selected listening mode family does not offer a listening mode for the  
current Main Zone input source.  
When a 7-speaker configuration is in use, the DPLIIx variant of this mode is loaded.  
†† The MODE SELECTION NOT AVAILABLE message appears on the on-screen and front panel displays if the input has a sampling rate of 96kHz. This includes analog inputs converted to 96kHz.  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                 
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
LISTENING MODE DESCRIPTIONS  
The MC-12 offers an assortment of listening modes for 2-channel, Dolby Digital, DTS-ES, analog, and microphone sources. Listening mode  
descriptions begin below and continue in the order shown on the MODE ADJUST menu. The table included with each description indicates the  
corresponding listening mode menu parameters, as well as their factory-default and possible parameter settings. All listening mode menus are  
shown in the Appendix. Descriptions of the listening mode parameters begin on page 5-37.  
FILM  
TV  
FILM  
MODE ADJUST  
TV  
MODE ADJUST  
This listening mode designed for enhanced playback of 2-channel  
stereo or matrix-encoded film sources.  
This listening mode is designed for playback of 2-channel stereo or  
matrix-encoded television broadcast sources.  
LOGIC 7 FILM is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode that derives  
seven channels from 2-channel input sources. Logic 7 also derives  
full-frequency stereo surround channels that realistically increase  
the perceived width, length and sense of envelopment of the  
listening space. Logic 7 provides remarkable improvement  
compared to other decoders.  
LOGIC 7 TV is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode based on the  
LOGIC 7 FILM listening mode, but specifically tailored for broadcast  
sources.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
AUTO AZIMUTH  
ON  
ON, OFF  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM  
ON, OFF  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
FILM  
OFF  
AUTO AZIMUTH  
ON  
ON, OFF  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
ON, OFF  
REAR  
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR  
ON, OFF  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
ON  
5 SPKR ENHANCE ON  
REAR  
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR  
ON, OFF  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
5 SPKR ENHANCE ON  
7.0kHz  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
15ms  
7.0kHz  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
Refer to page 5-35  
Refer to page 5-35  
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
MODE ADJUST  
MUSIC  
MODE ADJUST  
MUSIC SURR  
This listening mode is designed for playback of 2-channel stereo or  
matrix-encoded music sources.  
This listening mode is designed for playback of 2-channel stereo  
music sources recorded in real spaces and for playback of  
recordings that contain added reverb. It is recommended for  
classical music sources, which are often recorded in real spaces with  
added reverb to enhance the stereo mix.  
LOGIC 7 MUSIC is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode based on  
the LOGIC 7 FILM listening mode, but specifically tailored for music  
sources. .  
LOGIC 7 MUSIC SURR is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode that  
is similar to the MUSIC SURROUND listening mode in other Lexicon  
products. Logic 7 extracts ambient sounds from the input source  
and sends these sounds to all speakers. Ambient sounds are heard  
from all directions, creating a realistic playback presentation that  
simulates what listeners experience in real spaces.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
+0.0dB  
MUSIC  
NEUTRAL  
ON  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM  
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR  
ON, OFF  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
+0.0dB  
MSURR  
NEUTRAL  
ON  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM  
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR  
ON, OFF  
Refer to page 5-35  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
descriptions.  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
PLIIx +  
MODE ADJUST  
&
PLIIx +  
PLII +  
PLIIx MOV &  
PLII MOVIE  
OR  
OR  
PLII +  
MODE ADJUST  
MODE ADJUST  
MODE ADJUST  
PLII MOVIE  
PLIIx MOV  
The Dolby PLIIx + THX and Dolby PLII + THX listening modes are  
designed to playback 7.1 or 5.1 discrete channels decoded from  
2-channel Dolby Surround-encoded sources. The seven or five main  
channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as LFE  
information, has a limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The PLIIx  
listening mode is only available when the front, side and rear speakers  
are present.  
The Dolby PLIIx MOV (MOVIE) and Dolby PLII MOVIE listening modes  
are designed to playback 7.1 or 5.1 discrete channels decoded from  
2-channel Dolby Surround-encoded film sources. The seven or five  
main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as  
LFE information, has a limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The  
PLIIx listening mode is only available when the front, side and rear  
speakers are present.  
Note:  
Note:  
The PLIIx mode does not appear in the list of available listening modes if  
either the side or rear speakers are missing from the configuration.  
The PLIIx MOV mode does not appear in the list of available listening modes  
if either the side or rear speakers are missing from the configuration.  
The modes are recommended for home theaters with THX-certified  
speakers. Dolby PLII(x) + THX encoding:  
Dolby PLII MOVIE and Dolby PLIIx MOV modes:  
Are designed for playback of Dolby Surround-encoded sources.  
Apply THX re-equalization to simulate high-frequency rolloffs  
that occur in movie theaters. Most films are mixed for movie  
theaters, and might sound too bright when played back in  
home theaters without re-equalization.  
Provide impressive enhancement compared to Dolby Pro Logic  
decoding.  
Dolby PLII MOVIE decodes five channels from Dolby  
Surround-encoded sources. Dolby PLIIx MOV decodes seven  
channels from Dolby Surround-encoded sources.  
Apply THX timbre matching to minimize timbre differences  
between the front and surround channels, which results in  
smoother sound movements between them.  
Parameter  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
RE-EQUALIZER  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
ON, OFF  
Refer to page 5-35  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
PLIIx MUS &  
PLII MUSIC  
PL +  
MODE ADJUST  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
PLIIx MUS  
MODE ADJUST  
PLII MUSIC  
PL +  
The Dolby PLIIx MUS (MUSIC) and Dolby PLII MUSIC listening modes  
are designed to playback 7.1 or 5.1 discrete channels decoded from  
2-channel music sources. The seven or five main channels are full  
frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as LFE information, has a  
limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The PLIIx listening mode is  
only available when the front, side and rear speakers are present.  
This mode is designed for playback of Dolby Surround-encoded  
sources and decodes four channels: three front channels and one  
mono surround channel with a high-frequency rolloff above 7kHz.  
This mode is recommended for home theaters with THX-certified  
speakers. Dolby PL + THX mode:  
Applies THX re-equalization to simulate high-frequency rolloffs  
that occur in movie theaters. Most films are mixed for movie  
theaters, and may sound too bright when played back in home  
theaters without re-equalization.  
Note:  
The PLIIx MUS mode does not appear in the list of available listening modes  
if either the side or rear speakers are missing from the configuration.  
Applies THX timbre matching to minimize timbre differences  
between the front and surround channels, which results in  
smoother sound movements between them.  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
PANORAMA  
CTR WIDTH  
DIMENSION  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
3
MIN, 1 to 6, MAX  
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR  
0 to 15ms  
RE-EQUALIZER  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
ON, OFF  
NEUTRAL  
Refer to page 5-35  
SURROUND DLY 10ms  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
PRO LOGIC  
+
MODE ADJUST  
PRO LOGIC  
+
MODE ADJUST  
The Dolby PRO LOGIC mode is designed for playback of Dolby  
Surround-encoded sources. It decodes four channels from Dolby  
Surround-encoded sources, and uses a mono surround channel  
with a high-frequency rolloff above 7kHz.  
This mode is designed for playback of matrix-encoded digital stereo  
film sources. DTS NEO:6 derives six channels when both side and rear  
speakers are present (rear channels will be in parallel). It derives five  
channels when only side or rear speakers are present.  
This mode is useful for comparison purposes, particularly with the  
L7 FILM, Dolby PLIIx MOVIE and DTS Neo:6 CIN listening mode.  
In addition to THX processing, THX re-equalization is applied to  
simulate high-frequency rolloffs that occur in movie theaters. Most  
films are mixed for movie theaters, and may sound too bright when  
played back in home theaters without re-equalization.  
Parameter  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
Refer to page 5-35  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
RE-EQUALIZER  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
ON, OFF  
descriptions.  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
NIGHTCLUB  
CIN &  
MUSIC  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
NIGHTCLUB  
CIN  
MUSIC  
MODE ADJUST  
The NIGHTCLUB mode is designed for playback of “dry” music  
sources that benefit from the addition of room reflections,  
especially music sources that lack ambience in the recording. The  
NIGHTCLUB mode generates early reflections and sends them to  
the front, side and rear channels to simulate small, intimate  
listening spaces.  
These modes are designed for playback of matrix-encoded digital  
stereo film or music sources. DTS Neo:6 derives six channels when  
both side and rear speakers are present (rear channels will be in  
parallel). It derives five channels when only side or rear speakers are  
present. The LFE channel is generated through bass management in  
the MC-12.  
The NIGHTCLUB mode is a superior room simulation listening  
mode because it uses a proprietary reverb algorithm inherited from  
Lexicon professional products.  
Parameter  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
Refer to page 5-35  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
descriptions.  
CENTER DEPTH  
SPEECH DETECT  
SIZE  
11  
0 to 18  
ON  
ON, OFF  
5m  
4 to 20m  
Note the following:  
LIVENESS  
196ms  
30ms to 20.2s  
OFF, 1 to 100ms  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
-12 to +6dB  
The DTS Neo:6 CIN or MUSIC listening modes cannot be  
assigned as preferred listening modes for 2-channel sources.  
However, when the 2-CH parameter is set to USE LAST, the  
MC-12 automatically activates the DTS Neo:6 CIN or MUSIC  
listening mode if the mode was active the last time a 2-channel  
source was present.  
PRE-DELAY  
ROLLOFF  
5ms  
9.0kHz  
EFFECT LVL  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
+3dB  
Refer to page 5-35  
The MC-12 will not automatically activate a DTS Neo:6 listening  
mode unless a 44.1kHz or 48kHz PCM digital source is present.  
The DTS Neo:6 listening modes are not available with 88.2kHz  
or 96kHz, Dolby Digital, or analog sources.  
descriptions.  
The DTS Neo:6 MUSIC listening mode can be activated with  
the front-panel or remote control Mode buttons. The DTS  
Neo:6 CIN listening mode can also activated with the remote  
control DTS button when a 2-channel input source is present.  
5-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
CONCERT HALL  
CHURCH  
MODE ADJUST  
CONCERT HALL  
MODE ADJUST  
CHURCH  
The CONCERT HALL mode generates early reflections and sends  
them to the front, side and rear channels to simulate large listening  
spaces.  
The CHURCH mode uses a reverb algorithm to emphasize the rich,  
smooth, reverberant decay characteristic of small and medium  
listening spaces with long reverberation time relative to their size,  
such as churches and chambers.  
The CONCERT HALL mode is a superior room simulation listening  
mode because it uses a proprietary reverb algorithm inherited from  
Lexicon professional products.  
The CHURCH mode is a superior room simulation listening mode  
because it uses a proprietary reverb algorithm inherited from  
Lexicon professional products.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
CENTER DEPTH  
SPEECH DETECT  
SIZE  
12  
0 to 18  
CENTER DEPTH  
SPEECH DETECT  
SIZE*  
5
0 to 18  
ON  
ON, OFF  
ON  
ON, OFF  
20m  
4 to 20m  
20m  
4 to 30m  
LIVENESS  
1.72s  
30ms to 20.2s  
OFF, 1 to 100ms  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
-12 to +6dB  
MID RT*  
1.56s  
24ms to 24.3s  
5ms to 48.6s  
OFF, 1 to 100ms  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
-12 to +6dB  
PRE-DELAY  
ROLLOFF  
OFF  
BASS RT*  
1.87s  
2.4kHz  
PRE-DELAY  
ROLLOFF  
24ms  
EFFECT LVL  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
-2dB  
2.4kHz  
Refer to page 5-35  
EFFECT LVL  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
-3dB  
Refer to page 5-35  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
* BASS RT, MID RT, and SIZE parameter settings are interdependent, meaning that the full  
parameter range might not be available depending on the other parameter settings.  
descriptions.  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
MODE ADJUST  
CATHEDRAL  
MODE ADJUST  
PANORAMA  
The CATHEDRAL mode is similar to the CHURCH listening mode. It  
uses a reverb algorithm to emphasize the rich, smooth, reverberant  
decay characteristic of large listening spaces with long reverber-  
ation time relative to their size, such as cathedrals.  
The PANORAMA mode is designed for playback of stereo and  
matrix-encoded sources. PANORAMA uses proprietary Lexicon  
algorithms to move the stereo image outward from the front  
speakers, producing a wider stereo field with greater depth.  
The CATHEDRAL mode is a superior room simulation listening  
mode because it uses a proprietary reverb algorithm inherited from  
Lexicon professional products.  
Sound quality depends on proper location of the listening position  
and front speakers. When the front speakers are positioned close to  
either side of the display device, the effect is produced over a wider  
area than when the front speakers are positioned at a large angle  
from the display device.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
CENTER DEPTH  
SPEECH DETECT  
SIZE*  
12  
0 to 18  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
ON  
ON, OFF  
EFFECT LVL  
+4dB  
STEREO  
+0  
-12 to +6dB  
30m  
4 to 30m  
BASS CONTENT  
LOW FREQ WIDTH  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
INPUT BALANCE  
CALIBRATION  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
BINAURL, MONO, STEREO  
-25 to +25dB  
MID RT*  
3.72s  
24ms to 24.3s  
5ms to 48.6s  
OFF, 1 to 100ms  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
-12 to +6dB  
BASS RT*  
4.47s  
3.1kHz  
15ms  
<|>  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
PRE-DELAY  
ROLLOFF  
23ms  
3.1kHz  
L< to <|> to >R  
EFFECT LVL  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
-8dB  
Refer to next column  
Refer to page 5-35  
*
BASS RT, MID RT, and SIZE parameter settings are interdependent, meaning that the  
full parameter range might not be available depending on the other parameter  
settings.  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
PANORAMA CALIBRATION  
CALIBRATION  
MODE ADJUST  
PANORAMA  
Select PANORAMA CALIBRATION to open  
the PANORAMA CALIBRATION menu shown  
to the left, to calibrate the PANORAMA  
listening mode. This listening mode must be  
calibrated to take full advantage of its  
effects.  
An external calibration source is required to calibrate the  
PANORAMA listening mode. You should select a familiar stereo  
source.  
PANORAMA CALIBRATION  
SOURCE LEFT & RIGHT  
SPEAKER ANGLE 30deg  
LISTENER POS  
+0  
NOTE:  
ENSURE THAT  
“SPEAKER SETUP” HAS  
BEEN PROPERLY  
PERFORMED  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
SOURCE  
LEFT & RIGHT  
30deg  
RIGHT, LEFT & RIGHT, LEFT  
For best results, you should center the  
primary listening position between the front  
left and right speakers as shown in illus-  
SPEAKER ANGLE  
LISTENER POS  
10deg to 90deg  
-127 to +127  
+0  
tration B at the top of the next page (center). Otherwise, the  
PANORAMA listening mode will be calibrated with varying results.  
descriptions.  
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
A
B
C
To calibrate the PANORAMA listening mode:  
buttons. Each increment within the –127 to +127 parameter  
range represents about one-third of an inch. Illustration A  
shows the left of center position. Illustration C shows the right  
of center position  
1. Remove all obstructions between the speakers and the primary  
listening position.  
2. Make sure the distances between the speakers and the primary  
listening position are properly measured. To do this, select one  
of the following options.  
4. Set the SOURCE parameter to RIGHT.  
5. Begin playback of the external calibration source.  
6. When playback of the external calibration source is in progress,  
set the SPEAKER ANGLE parameter so the sound is not heard in  
the right ear.  
Select the AUTO SPEAKER SETUP menu DISTANCES option to  
have the MC-12 automatically calibrate speaker distances.  
Measure the distance between the primary listening posi-  
tion and the front baffle of each speaker. Then, set the cor-  
responding SPEAKER DISTANCES menu parameters to the  
closest available value.  
7. To confirm the LISTENER POS and SPEAKER ANGLE parameter  
settings, set the SOURCE parameter to LEFT & RIGHT. If the  
PANORAMA listening mode is properly calibrated, the sound  
should be perceived to come from all around the primary  
listening position. If not, go back to Step 1 and repeat the cali-  
bration procudure.  
3. Sit in the primary listening position. If the primary listening  
position is not centered between the front left and right  
speakers as shown in illustration B (above), set the PANORAMA  
CALIBRATION LISTENER POS parameter to compensate for  
the difference using the remote control and arrow  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
2-CH SURROUND  
MONO LOGIC  
MODE ADJUST  
2-CH SURROUND  
MODE ADJUST  
MONO LOGIC  
This mode, designed for playback of stereo sources, sends the left  
channel to Front, Side, and Rear Left channels and the right channel  
to Front, Side and Rear Right channels, and sums the Left and Right  
for the center. It is recommended for background music.  
This mode, designed for playback of mono sources, uses proprietary  
Lexicon reverb algorithms to realistically expand mono sources to  
use all channels. This dramatically increases the perceived width  
and sense of envelopment of the listening space.  
Parameter  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
Refer to page 5-35  
EFFECT LVL  
-9dB  
-12dB to +6dB  
ON, OFF  
ACADEMY FILTER  
SURR ROLLOFF  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
3.1kHz  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
descriptions.  
2-CHANNEL  
descriptions.  
MODE ADJUST  
2-CHANNEL  
This mode, designed for playback of stereo sources, sends the left and  
right channels to the Front L/R and Subwoofer channels. It is recom-  
mended for two-speaker playback with subwoofers and for  
comparison purposes with other listening modes.  
Note:  
When the remote control Shift command bank is activated, pressing the  
TVL button activates the MONO LOGIC listening mode for 2-channel  
sources.  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
SUB LEVEL  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
OFF, -30dB to +12dB  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
MONO SURROUND  
5.1 FILM  
MODE ADJUST  
MONO SURROUND  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1  
FILM  
This mode, designed for playback of mono sources, sends the  
mono source to all channels.  
The 5.1 L7 FILM mode is a proprietary Lexicon listening mode  
designed for playback of 5.1-channel Dolby Digital-encoded film  
sources, and provides remarkable improvement compared to other  
decoders.  
Parameter  
It derives seven channels from 5.1-channel input sources with  
enhanced front steering. When both side and rear speakers are  
present, the 5.1 L7 FILM listening mode also increases the perceived  
length and sense of envelopment of the listening space.  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
MONO  
MODE ADJUST  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
+0.0dB  
FILM  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
MONO  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC,  
FILM  
This mode, designed for playback of mono sources, sends mono  
sources to the center channel.  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
ON  
ON, OFF  
REAR  
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT  
ON, OFF  
ON  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
SUB LEVEL  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
OFF, -30dB to +12dB  
7kHz  
500HZ to 20kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1ms to 30ms  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-10.0dB to +0.0dB  
Refer to page 5-35  
15ms  
descriptions.  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
descriptions.  
5-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
5.1 MUSIC  
5.1  
TV  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1  
MUSIC  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1  
TV  
This proprietary Lexicon listening mode is designed for playback of  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital-encoded music sources. Based on the 5.1  
L7 FILM listening mode, 5.1 L7 MUSIC derives seven channels from  
5.1-channel input sources with enhanced front steering.  
This proprietary Lexicon listening mode is designed for playback of  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital-encoded broadcast sources. Based on the  
5.1 L7 FILM listening mode, 5.1 L7 TV derives seven channels from  
5.1-channel input sources with enhanced front steering.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
+0.0dB  
MUSIC  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
+0.0dB  
FILM  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC,  
FILM  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC,  
FILM  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OFF  
OFF, ON  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OFF  
OFF, ON  
NEUTRAL  
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT  
ON, OFF  
REAR  
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT  
ON, OFF  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
7kHz  
500HZ to 20kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1ms to 30ms  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-10.0dB to +0.0dB  
7kHz  
500HZ to 20kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1ms to 30ms  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-10.0dB to +0.0dB  
15ms  
15ms  
OFF  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
,
UL2Cin &  
SurEX  
OR  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
UL2Cin  
SurEX  
These modes are designed for 7-channel playback of 5.1-channel  
Dolby Digital film sources that do not have THX Surround EX  
encoding. They apply THX re-equalization to simulate  
high-frequency rolloffs that occur in movie theaters. Most films are  
mixed for movie theaters, and might sound too bright when played  
back in home theaters without re-equalization. THX timbre  
matching is applied to minimize timbre differences between the  
front and surround channels, which results in smoother sound  
movements between them. These modes are recommended for  
home theaters with THX-certified speakers.  
non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source with or without  
THX Surround EX encoding is detected.  
The THX SurEX listening mode is available when both the side  
and rear speakers are present and THX Surround EX decoding  
is engaged. THX Surround EX decoding is engaged when the  
SURROUND EX parameter is set to ON or AUTO and a flagged  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital source with THX Surround EX  
encoding is detected.  
The THX listening mode is available when both Ultra2 and THX  
Surround EX decoding are deactivated.  
The listening mode name differs depending on the encoding  
present in the input source, the SURROUND EX parameter setting,  
and the speaker setup.  
Note:  
Some EX encoded sources are not flagged, and require manually  
setting the SURROUND EX parameter to ON for EX decoding.  
The table at the bottom of the page shows the conditions for the  
behavior of the THX Ultra2 and THX Surround EX modes when  
activated:  
When THX Ultra2 decoding is active:  
Adaptive de-correlation is applied to increase the perceived  
width of the listening space. De-correlation of the mono  
surround channel increases the perceived width of the  
surround field in home theaters.  
The THX ULTRA2 listening mode is available when both the  
side and rear speakers are present and THX Ultra2 decoding is  
engaged. THX Ultra2 decoding is engaged when the  
SURROUND EX parameter is set to OFF or AUTO and a  
Input Source  
5.1-Channel THX Surround EX  
Dolby Digital (Flagged)  
5.1-Channel THX Surround EX  
Dolby Digital (Non-Flagged)  
5.1-Channel Dolby Digital  
Parameter Setting  
THX ULTRA2  
THX SurEX  
THX SurEX  
THX SurEX  
THX ULTRA2  
THX ULTRA2  
THX SurEX  
SURROUND EX: AUTO  
SURROUND EX: ON  
SURROUND EX: OFF  
THX ULTRA2  
THX ULTRA2  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
MC-12  
ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear speakers.  
Mode Adjust  
MUSIC  
MODE ADJUST  
Refer to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32 for more  
information.  
MUSIC  
This listening mode is designed for playback of 5.1-channel Dolby  
Digital music sources, and cannot be activated unless side and rear  
speakers are present. ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the  
rear speakers. Refer to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32  
for more information. For best results, place the rear speakers close  
together in your home theater.  
When THX Surround EX decoding is active:  
Matrix decoding is applied to derive three surround channels from  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources.  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
Note:  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SURROUND EX  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
ON  
ON, OFF  
The THX MUSIC listening mode can only be activated with the front panel  
or remote control Mode buttons.  
AUTO  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
OFF  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
+0.0dB  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OFF  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
+0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
MODE ADJUST  
MODE ADJUST  
The 5.1 PLIIx MUS (MUSIC) listening mode is designed to playback 7.1  
discrete channels decoded from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital music  
sources. (The 5.1 PLIIx MUSIC listening mode can also be used with  
other types of Dolby Digital sources with mixed results.) The seven  
main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as  
LFE information, has a limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The 5.1  
PLIIx MUSIC listening mode is only available when the front, side and  
rear speakers are present.  
The 5.1 PLIIx MOV (MOVIE) listening mode is designed to playback  
7.1 discrete channels decoded from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital film  
sources. (The 5.1 PLIIx MOVIE listening mode can also be used with  
other types of Dolby Digital sources with mixed results.) The seven  
main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to as  
LFE information, has a limited frequency range of up to 120Hz. The 5.1  
PLIIx MOVIE listening mode is only available when the front, side and  
rear speakers are present.  
Note the following:  
Note the following:  
The 5.1 PLIIx MUS listening mode cannot be assigned as the  
preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources. However, when  
the 2-CH parameter is set to USE LAST, the MC-12 automati-  
cally activates the 5.1 PLIIx MUS listening mode if the 5.1  
PLIIx MUS listening mode was activated the last time a  
2-channel source was present.  
The 5.1 PLIIx MOV listening mode cannot be assigned as the  
preferred listening mode for 2-channel sources. However, when  
the 2-CH parameter is set to USE LAST, the MC-12 automati-  
cally activates the 5.1 PLIIx MOV listening mode if the 5.1  
PLIIx MOV listening mode was activated the last time a  
2-channel source was present.  
The 5.1 PLIIx MUS mode does not appear in the list of available  
listening modes if either the side or rear speakers are missing  
from the configuration.  
The 5.1 PLIIx MOV mode does not appear in the list of available  
listening modes if either the side or rear speakers are missing  
from the configuration.  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
EX DECODING  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
AUTO  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
EX DECODING  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
AUTO  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded with Dolby Digital  
Surround EX encoding is detected.  
DIGITAL &  
DIGITAL EX  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL EX  
Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding is not activated when the  
EX DECODING parameter is set to OFF or AUTO and a  
non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded with or  
without Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding is detected.  
These listening modes are designed to decode and playback 5.1  
discrete channels from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. The five  
main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel, often referred to  
as LFE information, has a limited frequency range of 120Hz.  
Note:  
The mode name differs depending on the encoding present in the  
input source, the EX DECODING parameter setting, and the  
speaker setup.  
The MC-12 cannot detect Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding in  
non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital input sources because they do  
not include information in the input signal that identifies Dolby Digital  
Surround EX encoding.  
The Dolby DIGITAL EX listening mode is recommended for Dolby  
Digital sources recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding.  
This listening mode can also be used with other types of  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources with mixed results. The table at  
the bottom of the page shows the conditions for the behavior of  
the Dolby Digital EX mode when activated.  
The Dolby DIGITAL listening mode is available when both the side  
and rear speakers are present and Dolby Digital Surround EX  
decoding is not activated.  
The Dolby DIGITAL EX listening mode is available when both the  
side and rear speakers are present and Dolby Digital Surround EX  
decoding is activated. Matrix decoding is then applied to derive a  
surround back channel from the other surround channels.  
Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding is activated when the EX  
DECODING parameter is set to ON or AUTO and a flagged  
Input Source  
5.1-Channel Surround EX  
(Flagged)  
5.1-Channel Surround EX  
(Non-Flagged)  
5.1-Channel Dolby Digital  
Parameter Setting  
DOLBY DIGITAL  
DOLBY DIGITAL EX  
DOLBY DIGITAL  
DOLBY DIGITAL EX  
DOLBY DIGITAL EX  
DOLBY DIGITAL  
DOLBY DIGITAL  
DOLBY DIGITAL EX  
DOLBY DIGITAL  
EX DECODING: AUTO  
EX DECODING: ON  
EX DECODING: OFF  
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
DIGITAL &  
DIGITAL EX (continued)  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
MODE ADJUST  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL EX  
This mode, recommended for recording purposes, is designed for  
converting 5.1-channel Dolby Digital-encoded input sources into  
2-channel Logic 7-encoded output signals.  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
EX DECODING  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
AUTO  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
OFF  
The downmixed 5.1-channel Dolby Digital input signals are sent to  
the front speakers and subwoofer.  
+0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
descriptions.  
CENTER MIX  
SURROUND MIX  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES  
MASTER LEVEL  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
+0dB  
-25 to +5dB  
+0dB  
-5 to +5dB  
+0  
-127 to +127  
-5 to +5dB  
+0dB  
OFF  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
-20.0 to +0.0dB  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
+0.0dB  
SUB LEVEL  
+0dB  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
5.1 MONO SURR  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1 MONO SURR  
This listening mode, designed for playback of Dolby  
Digital-encoded mono sources, uses proprietary Lexicon reverb  
algorithms to realistically expand mono sources to use all channels.  
This dramatically increases the perceived width and sense of envel-  
opment of the listening space.  
This listening mode, designed for playback of Dolby  
Digital-encoded mono sources, sends mono signals to all channels.  
Parameter  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
Refer to page 5-35  
Note that:  
When a 1.0 Dolby Digital source is present, the MC-12 auto-  
matically activates the 5.1 MONO LOGIC listening mode.  
descriptions.  
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the TVL  
button activates the 5.1 MONO LOGIC listening mode for  
5.1-channel sources.  
5.1 MONO  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1 MONO  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
EFFECT LVL  
-9dB  
-12 to +6dB  
This listening mode, designed for playback of Dolby  
Digital-encoded mono sources, sends mono signals to the center  
channel.  
ACADEMY FILTER  
SURR ROLLOFF  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
ON, OFF  
3.1kHz  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
Refer to page 5-35  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
SUB LEVEL  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
DECODING  
The DTS and DTS-ES listening modes are designed for, at a  
minimum, playback of 5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel matrix  
encoded DTS-ES, and 6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES  
sources.  
DTS-ES decoding is activated when both the side and rear  
speakers are present and the ES DECODING parameter is set to  
ON or AUTO and a 5.1-channel matrix-encoded or a  
6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES source is detected.  
DTS-ES decoding is deactivated when the ES DECODING  
parameter is set to OFF or when the ES DECODING parameter  
is set to AUTO and a 5.1-channel DTS source is detected.  
DTS and DTS-ES listening mode names differ depending on the  
encoding present in the input source, the DECODING parameter  
setting, and the speaker setup.  
DTS-ES listening modes are available when DTS-ES decoding is  
activated. The table at the bottom of the page shows the conditions  
for the behavior of DTS-ES decoding when it is activated.  
Note:  
The table below is not applicable to the DTS-ES THX, DTS THX ULTRA2,  
and DTS THX MUSIC listening modes.  
Input Source  
5.1-Channel  
Matrix-Encoded DTS-ES  
6.1-Channel  
Discrete-Encoded DTS-ES  
5.1-Channel DTS  
Parameter Setting  
DTS  
DTS-ES  
DTS  
DTS-ES  
DTS-ES  
DTS  
DTS-ES  
DTS-ES  
DTS  
ES DECODING: AUTO  
ES DECODING: ON  
ES DECODING: OFF  
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
FILM &  
FILM  
MUSIC &  
MUSIC  
OR  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
FILM  
FILM  
MODE ADJUST  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
These proprietary Lexicon listening modes use an advanced matrix to  
decode seven channels from 5.1 and 6.1-channel film sources with  
enhanced front steering. When both side and rear speakers are  
present, the DTS-ES L7 FILM listening mode also increases the  
perceived length and sense of envelopment of the listening space.  
These proprietary Lexicon listening modes, similar to the DTS-ES L7  
FILM listening mode, use an advanced matrix to decode seven  
channels from 5.1- and 6.1-channel music sources with enhanced  
front steering to provide remarkable sound improvement compared  
to other decoders. They are designed for enhanced playback of  
5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel matrix-encoded DTS-ES, or 6.1-channel  
discrete encoded DTS-ES music sources.  
The listening modes are designed for enhanced playback of  
5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel matrix-encoded DTS-ES, or 6.1-channel  
discrete encoded DTS-ES film sources. The listening mode name differs  
depending on the encoding present in the input source, the ES  
DECODING parameter setting, and the speaker setup.  
The listening mode name differs depending on the encoding  
present in the input source, the ES DECODING parameter setting,  
and the speaker setup.  
Option/Parameter Default Setting Possible Settings  
Option/Parameter Default Setting Possible Settings  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM  
ON, OFF  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM  
ON, OFF  
FILM  
MUSIC  
ON  
OFF  
REAR  
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT  
ON, OFF  
NEUTRAL  
ON  
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT  
ON, OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
7kHz  
500Hz to 20kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
7kHz  
500Hz to 20kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
15ms  
15ms  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
ES DECODING  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
AUTO  
ES DECODING  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
AUTO  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
&
UL2Cin  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
UL2Cin  
The DTS THX UL2Cin (ULTRA2 CINEMA) and DTS-ES THX listening  
modes allow 7-channel playback of 5.1-channel DTS sources that  
lack DTS-ES encoding. They are designed for playback of 5.1-channel  
DTS, 5.1-channel matrix encoded DTS-ES, or 6.1-channel DTS-ES  
discrete-encoded film sources. DTS THX UL2Cin and DTS-ES THX  
are recommended for home theaters with THX-certified speakers.  
These modes apply:  
When THX UL2Cin decoding is activated:  
Adaptive de-correlation is applied to increase the perceived  
width of the listening space. De-correlation of the mono  
surround channel increases the perceived width of the  
surround field in home theaters.  
ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear speakers.  
Refer to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32 for more  
information.  
THX re-equalization to simulate high-frequency rolloffs that  
occur in movie theaters. Most films are mixed for movie  
theaters, and might sound too bright when played back in  
home theaters without re-equalization.  
The DTS-ES THX listening mode  
The DTS-ES THX listening mode is available when both the side and  
rear speakers are present and DTS-ES decoding is active.  
THX timbre matching to minimize timbre differences between  
the front and surround channels, which results in smoother  
sound movements between them.  
DTS-ES decoding is activated when the ES DECODING parameter is  
set to AUTO (the default) or ON and a 5.1-channel matrix-encoded  
or 6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES source is detected.  
The listening mode name differs depending on the encoding present  
in the input source, the ES DECODING parameter setting, and the  
speaker setup.  
The table at the bottom of the page shows the conditions for the  
behavior of the DTS THX UL2Cin and DTS-ES THX modes when  
activated:.  
The DTS THX UL2Cin listening mode  
The DTS THX UL2Cin listening mode is available when when both side  
and rear speakers are present and THX Ultra2 decoding is activated.  
Option/Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
To activate DTS THX UL2Cin decoding:  
RE-EQUALIZER  
LFE MIX  
ON  
ON, OFF  
1. Press MODE ADJUST ꢀ  
DECODING.  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
2. Use the or arrow to select either AUTO (the default) or OFF.  
ES DECODING  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
AUTO  
When the the ES DECODING parameter is set to OFF the DTS-ES  
THX ULTRA2 listening mode is always active. When the parameter  
is set to AUTO the DTS-ES THX ULTRA2 listening mode activates  
when a 5.1-channel DTS source is detected.  
Refer to page 5-35  
detaileddescriptions.  
5-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
Input Source  
5.1-Channel  
Matrix-Encoded DTS-ES  
6.1-Channel  
Discrete-Encoded DTS-ES  
5.1-Channel DTS  
Parameter Setting  
DTS THX UL2Cin  
DTS-ES THX  
DTS-ES THX  
DTS-ES THX  
DTS-ES THX  
ES DECODING: AUTO  
ES DECODING: ON  
ES DECODING: OFF  
DTS-ES THX  
DTS THX UL2Cin  
DTS THX UL2Cin  
DTS THX UL2Cin  
MUSIC  
&
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
MUSIC  
MODE ADJUST  
This mode decodes 5.1 matrix or 6.1 discrete channels from DTS-ES  
sources. It is designed for playback of 5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel  
matrix encoded DTS-ES, and 6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES  
sources.  
The DTS THX MUSIC listening mode is designed for playback of  
5.1-channel DTS music sources when the side and rear speakers are  
present. ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear  
more information. This mode is recommended for home theaters  
with THX-certified speaker setups.  
The six decoded main channels are full frequency. The .1 channel,  
often referred to as LFE information, has a limited frequency range  
of 120Hz.  
Option/Parameter Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
The listening mode name differs depending on the encoding  
present in the input source, the DECODING parameter setting, and  
the speaker setup. Refer to page 5-21 for more information.  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
Option/Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
descriptions.  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
ES DECODING  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
AUTO  
Note:  
The DTS THX MUSIC listening mode can only be activated with the front  
panel or remote control Mode buttons.  
descriptions.  
5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
5.1a  
FILM  
2-CHAN &  
2-CHAN  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1  
FILM  
MODE ADJUST  
2-CHAN OR  
2-CHAN  
The 5.1a LOGIC 7 FILM listening mode is a proprietary Lexicon  
listening mode that uses Logic 7 decoding to derive seven channels  
from of 5.1-channel analog film sources with enhanced front  
steering.  
These modes, recommended for recording purposes, send  
downmixed 5.1-channel or 6.1-channel DTS-ES input signals to the  
front speakers and subwoofer as 2-channel Logic 7-encoded output  
signals.  
This listening mode allows 5.1-channel analog sources to use bass  
management, speaker crossovers, speaker distance calibration, and  
audio controls (tone controls).  
Option/Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
CENTER MIX  
+0dB  
+0dB  
-25 to +5dB  
SURROUND MIX  
-5 to +5dB  
Option/Parameter Default Setting Possible Settings  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0  
-127 to +127  
-5 to +5dB  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM  
ON, OFF  
MASTER LEVEL  
LFE MIX  
+0dB  
FILM  
+0.0dB  
-20.0 to +0.0dB  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
OFF  
ES DECODING  
SUB LEVEL  
AUTO  
REAR  
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT  
ON, OFF  
+0dB  
ON  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
descriptions.  
7kHz  
500Hz to 20kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
15ms  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
descriptions.  
5-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
5.1a MUSIC  
5.1a  
UL2Cin, 5.1a  
SurEX, & 5.1a  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1a  
MUSIC  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
OR  
5.1a  
UL2Cin  
5.1a  
SurEX  
5.1a  
The 5.1a LOGIC 7 MUSIC listening mode is similiar to the 5.1a  
LOGIC 7 FILM listening mode, but specifically tailored for music  
sources. This mode is designed and recommended for playback of  
5.1-channel analog music sources.  
The 5.1a THX UL2Cin, 5.1a THX SurEX, and 5.1a THX listening  
modes are designed to convert 5.1-channel analog film sources that  
lack THX Surround EX encoding into seven channel audio. The  
modes also allow 5.1-channel analog sources to use bass  
management, speaker crossovers, speaker distance calibration, and  
audio controls (tone controls). The 5.1a THX UL2Cin, 5.1a THX  
SurEX, and 5.1a THX listening modes are recommended for home  
theaters with THX-certified speakers. These modes apply:  
Option/Parameter Default Setting Possible Settings  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM  
ON, OFF  
MUSIC  
THX re-equalization to simulate high-frequency rolloffs that  
occur in movie theaters. Most films are mixed for movie  
theaters, and might sound too bright when played back in  
home theaters without re-equalization.  
OFF  
NEUTRAL  
ON  
REAR, NEUTRAL, FRONT  
ON, OFF  
THX timbre matching to minimize timbre differences between  
the front and surround channels, which results in smoother  
sound movements between them.  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
7kHz  
500Hz to 20kHz, OFF  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
The listening mode name differs depending on the SURROUND EX  
parameter setting, and the speaker setup.  
15ms  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
The table at the top of the next page indicates the conditions in  
which THX Ultra2 and THX Surround EX decoding are activated.  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
5.1a  
UL2Cin, 5.1a  
SurEX, & 5.1a  
(continued)  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
OR  
5.1a  
UL2Cin  
5.1a  
SurEX  
5.1a  
Input Source  
5.1-Channel THX Surround EX  
Analog (Flagged)  
5.1-Channel THX Surround EX  
5.1-Channel Analog  
Parameter Setting  
Analog (Non-Flagged)  
5.1a THX SurEX  
5.1a THX SurEX  
5.1a THX SurEX  
SURROUND EX: ON  
SURROUND EX: OFF  
5.1a THX ULTRA2  
5.1a THX ULTRA2  
5.1a THX ULTRA2  
The 5.1a THX UL2Cin listening mode  
The 5.1a THX UL2Cin listening mode is available when both side  
and rear speakers are present and THX Ultra2 decoding is active. THX  
Ultra2 decoding is activated when the SURROUND EX parameter is  
set to OFF. When THX Ultra2 decoding is activated:  
When THX Surround EX decoding is activated Matrix decoding is  
applied to derive three surround channels from 5.1-channel analog  
sources.  
The 5.1a THX listening mode  
Adaptive de-correlation is applied to increase the perceived  
width of the listening space. De-correlation of the mono  
surround channel increases the perceived width of the  
surround field in home theaters.  
The 5.1a THX listening mode is available when neither THX Ultra2  
nor THX Surround EX decoding is active.  
ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear speakers.  
Refer to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32 for more  
information.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SURROUND EX  
LFE MIX  
ON  
ON, OFF  
OFF  
ON, OFF  
The 5.1a THX SurEX listening mode  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
The 5.1a THX SurEX listening mode is available when both side and  
rear speakers are present and THX surround EX decoding is active.  
THX Surround EX decoding is activated when the SURROUND EX  
parameter is set to ON.  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a  
MUSIC  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1a STANDARD  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1a  
MUSIC  
This mode allows 5.1-channel analog sources to use bass  
management, speaker crossovers, speaker distance calibration, and  
audio controls (tone controls). When these features are not used,  
the 5.1a STANDARD listening mode is similar to the 5.1a BYPASS  
listening mode. The 5.1a STANDARD mode sends identical signals  
(with appropriate time delays) to the Main Zone audio output  
connectors labeled Side L and Rear L, as well as Side R and Rear R.  
The 5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode is designed for playback of  
5.1-channel analog music sources. It cannot be activated unless side  
and rear speakers are present. This mode performs best in home  
theaters where the rear speakers are placed close together.  
ASA processing is applied to signals sent to the rear speakers. Refer  
to the ASA parameter description on page 3-32 for more  
information.  
Parameter  
Option/Parameter Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
Refer to page 5-35  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
-10.0 to +0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
descriptions.  
Note:  
The 5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode can only be activated with the front  
panel or remote control Mode buttons.  
5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
5.1a BYPASS  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
MODE ADJUST  
5.1a BYPASS  
This mode downmixes 5.1-channel analog input signals into  
2-channel Logic 7-encoded output signals. It sends these signals to  
the front speakers and the subwoofer. It is recommended for  
recording purposes, particularly for recording from a DVD-A or  
multi-channel SACD player to a CD-R or another 2-channel  
recording format.  
Designed for playback of 5.1-channel analog sources, such as  
DVD-A or SACD players.  
Sends the 5.1-channel analog audio input connector directly to  
the Main Zone volume control and audio output connectors as  
shown on page 2-6 and page 3-59. These signals receive no  
internal processing.  
When both side and rear speakers are present, surround  
channel signals are sent in parallel to the side and rear speakers.  
To configure a 5-channel speaker setup, set the OUTPUT  
LEVELS menu SIDE L/R or REAR L/R parameter to OFF to deacti-  
vate the associated surround speakers.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
CENTER MIX  
+0dB  
+0dB  
-25 to +5dB  
SURROUND MIX  
-5 to +5dB  
The 5.1a BYPASS listening mode is automatically activated  
whenever the 5.1-channel analog audio input connector is  
assigned to the selected input. The 5.1a BYPASS listening mode  
is only available for 5.1-channel analog sources.  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0  
-127 to +127  
-5 to +5dB  
MASTER LEVEL  
LFE MIX  
+0dB  
+0.0dB  
-20.0 to +0.0dB  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
Pressing the remote control SHIFT then 2CH buttons toggles  
the MAIN ADV menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter between ON  
and OFF.  
SUB L/R LVL  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
Refer to page 5-35  
descriptions.  
Option/Parameter  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
descriptions.  
Note:  
Speaker crossover settings, speaker distances, and audio controls (tone)  
are not available when the 5.1a BYPASS listening mode is activated.  
5-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
2CH BYPASS  
LIVE! SMALL, LIVE! MED & LIVE! LARGE  
OR  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
2CH BYPASS  
MODE ADJUST  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! LARGE  
This listening mode sends 2-channel analog audio input signals to  
the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Front L/R with no  
internal processing.  
LIVE! (Lexicon Intelligent Variable Environment) is a proprietary  
mode designed to transform the way your listening room sounds.  
It provides a realistic illusion of a larger, more reverberant listening  
space. LIVE! SMALL simulates the reverberations of a room that is  
small, but larger than an average living room. LIVE! LARGE  
simulates the reverberations of a large hall. LIVE! requires two  
permanently mounted microphones. (See “LIVE! Calibration” on  
page 3-71 for placement and calibration instructions.) LIVE! cannot  
be used with prerecorded sources such as CD or DVD.  
The 2CH BYPASS listening mode is automatically activated  
whenever a 2-channel analog source is present and the MAIN ADV  
menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter is set to ON. The 2CH BYPASS  
listening mode is not available when a digital source is present and  
the MAIN ADV menu INPUT SELECT parameter is set to AUTO.  
Pressing the remote control SHIFT then 2CH buttons toggles the  
MAIN ADV menu ANALOG BYPASS parameter between ON and  
OFF.  
When LIVE! is activated, the BASS, TREBLE, and TILT EQ audio  
controls are set to +0.0dB and LOUDNESS is set to OFF, until LIVE! is  
deactivated.  
Note:  
LIVE! SMALL parameter settings:  
Speaker crossover settings, speaker distances, and audio controls (tone)  
are not available when the 2CH BYPASS listening mode is activated.  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
MID RT  
BASS RT  
597ms  
597ms  
3.1kHz  
3.1kHz  
10ms  
115ms to 15.4s  
23ms to 30.8ms  
500Hz to 20kHz  
500Hz to 20kHz  
10ms to 100ms  
ROLLOFF  
TREB CUT RT  
PRE-DELAY  
ADVANCED  
CUSTOM  
5-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
LIVE! MED ADVANCED parameter settings:  
LIVE! SMALL, LIVE! MED & LIVE! LARGE (continued)  
OR  
OR  
MODE ADJUST  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! LARGE  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
SHAPE  
SPREAD  
SIZE  
2
25%  
30m  
0 to 4  
0% to 100%  
4m to 60m  
LIVE! SMALL ADVANCED parameter settings:  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
REVERB LVL  
EARLY RFLX LVL  
BASS XOVER  
SHAPE  
SPREAD  
SIZE  
+0dB  
-13dB  
156Hz  
0
0%  
19m  
-80dB to +0dB  
-80dB to +12dB  
30Hz to 19.9kHz, OFF  
0 to 4  
0% to 100%  
4m to 60m  
LIVE! LARGE parameter settings:  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
MID RT  
4.71s  
115ms to 30.8s  
23ms to 30.8ms  
500Hz to 20kHz  
500Hz to 20kHz  
10ms to 100ms  
BASS RT  
4.71s  
ROLLOFF  
TREB CUT RT  
PRE-DELAY  
ADVANCED  
CUSTOM  
3.1kHz  
2.4kHz  
20ms  
LIVE! MED parameter settings:  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
MID RT  
BASS RT  
1.84s  
2.76s  
2.4kHz  
3.1kHz  
18ms  
115ms to 15.4s  
23ms to 30.8ms  
500Hz to 20kHz  
500Hz to 20kHz  
10ms to 100ms  
ROLLOFF  
TREB CUT RT  
PRE-DELAY  
ADVANCED  
CUSTOM  
LIVE! LARGE ADVANCED parameter settings:  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
REVERB LVL  
EARLY RFLX LVL  
BASS XOVER  
SHAPE  
-6dB  
-17dB  
156Hz  
2
-80dB to +0dB  
-80dB to +12dB  
30Hz to 19.9kHz, OFF  
0 to 4  
Refer to page 5-35  
SPREAD  
SIZE  
28%  
38m  
0% to 100%  
4m to 60m  
LIVE! MED ADVANCED parameter settings:  
Parameter  
Default Setting Possible Settings  
descriptions.  
REVERB LVL  
-4dB  
-80dB to +0dB  
EARLY RFLX LVL  
BASS XOVER  
-14dB  
156Hz  
-80dB to +12dB  
30Hz to 19.9kHz, OFF  
5-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
MODE ADJUST  
Listening Mode  
CUSTOM  
MODE ADJUST  
Listening Mode  
Opens the CUSTOM menu shown below, which can be used to  
compare custom and factory-default versions of the selected listening  
mode and to restore the factory-default version of the selected listening  
mode.  
Opens the OUTPUT LEVELS menu, which is  
used to adjust output levels for the Main  
Zone audio output connectors labeled  
Center, Subwoofer L/R, LFE, Side L/R, and  
Rear L/R.  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
LFE  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
CUSTOM VS PRESET  
MODE ADJUST  
Listening Mode  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM VS PRESET  
The OUTPUT LEVELS option does not appear on listening mode  
menus when the selected listening mode does not accommodate  
multi-channel output signals. Instead, an output-specific parameter  
appears. For example, the MONO listening mode menu includes a  
SUB L/R LVL parameter.  
Allows comparison listening between the custom and factory-default  
versions of the selected listening mode. When PRESET is selected, the  
listening mode is heard in its factory-default condition, as if all listening  
mode menu parameters were set to their factory-default settings.  
When CUSTOM is selected, the listening mode is heard it its custom  
condition, including all current listening mode menu parameter settings.  
The PRESET and CUSTOM versions of the selected listening mode will  
sound identical when all listening mode menu parameters are set to  
their factory-default settings.  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Possible Settings  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
Note:  
The CUSTOM VS PRESET option does not affect current listening mode  
menu parameter settings.  
LFE  
descriptions.  
PRESET  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM VS PRESET  
RESET MODE  
To toggle between the custom and factory-default versions of  
the selected listening mode:  
1. Follow the CUSTOM VS PRESET menu path to open the CUS-  
TOM VS PRESET drop-down menu.  
5-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
2. When the CUSTOM VS PRESET option drop-down menu is  
open, press the remote control and arrow buttons to  
toggle between the PRESET (factory-default) and CUSTOM  
versions of the selected listening mode.  
3. When finished, press the arrow button to close the  
CUSTOM VS PRESET drop down menu.  
RESET MODE  
MODE ADJUST  
Listening Mode  
CUSTOM  
RESET MODE  
Restores the factory-default version of the selected listening mode,  
restoring all listening mode menu parameters to their factory default  
settings.  
To restore the factory-default version of the selected listening mode:  
1. Follow the RESET MODE menu path to select the RESET MODE  
option. The PRESS RIGHT V TO RESTORE MODE message  
appears on the on-screen display.  
PRESS RIGHT V  
TO RESTORE MODE  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM VS PRESET  
RESET MODE  
2. Press the arrow button to restore the factory-default version of  
the selected listening mode. Press the arrow button to close the  
message without restoring the factory-default.  
Note:  
When the CUSTOM menu RESET MODE option is selected to restore the  
factory-default version of the selected listening mode, the corresponding  
TRIGGER SETUP menu listening mode parameter is automatically set to  
OFF.  
5-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS  
dummy head microphones. Select the MONO setting for sources  
recorded with mono bass. Select the STEREO setting for sources  
recorded with stereo bass. Available in PANORAMA mode.  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
ON, OFF  
Simulates 7-channel playback in 5-channel speaker configurations.  
When set to ON, the MC-12 provides an increased sense of  
spaciousness and envelopment through the surround speakers. This  
enhancement is most noticeable when the surround speakers are  
positioned to the side of the primary listening position, or when the  
primary listening position is located against the rear wall. The effec-  
tiveness of this parameter varies within the listening space. For best  
results, it is recommended that you position the surround speakers  
to the left and right sides of the primary listening position. Available  
in all Logic 7 modes.  
BASS ENHANCE  
ON, OFF  
Enhances stereo bass, which results in low-frequency reproduction  
that is less localizable and more realistic in the listening space. The  
effectiveness of the BASS ENHANCE parameter varies depending on  
room acoustics and the ability of the surround speakers to  
reproduce low frequencies. It is recommended that you use front,  
side or rear speakers that are capable of reproducing frequencies of  
40Hz or lower. Available in all Logic 7 modes.  
ACADEMY FILTER  
ON, OFF  
BASS RT  
5ms to 48.6s  
When set to ON, restores the proper tonal balance of older mono  
film sources that have much narrower frequency responses than  
more recent mono film sources. Available in MONO LOGIC and 5.1  
MONO LOGIC modes.  
Works with the MID RT and SIZE parameters to adjust the amount  
of time required for low-frequency information to decay below 60dB  
in level. In smaller listening spaces, the BASS RT parameter setting  
should match the MID RT parameter setting for more natural effects.  
Available in CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes  
AUTO AZIMUTH  
ON, OFF  
Maximizes matrix steering accuracy. When set to ON, the MC-12  
continually monitors the 2-channel input signal and automatically  
adjusts the relative level and time offset of the input channels to ensure  
that signals are sent to the appropriate channels with maximum  
separation. When set to OFF, the accuracy of the selected listening  
mode varies among sources. It is recommended that you set this  
parameter to ON for film and broadcast sources and to OFF for music  
sources. Available in L7 FILM and L7 TV modes.  
CAUTION!  
Setting the BASS RT, MID RT and SIZE parameters to a high  
value may produce undesirable or damaging audio.  
BASS XOVER  
30Hz to 19.9kHz, OFF  
Sets the frequency at which BASS RT applies. Available in all LIVE! modes.  
CALIBRATION  
BASS CONTENT  
BINAURAL, MONO, STEREO  
Opens the PANORAMA listening mode CALIBRATION menu, which is  
used to calibrate the PANORAMA listening mode. Refer to  
“PANORAMA” on page 5-12 for more information. Available in  
PANORAMA mode.  
Adjusts the bass content of binaural, mono and stereo recordings.  
When set to BINAURL, the MC-12 activates low-frequency compen-  
sation. Select this setting for true binaural sources recorded with  
5-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS (continued)  
Dolby Digital input sources that are listened to at lower volume levels,  
especially for nighttime viewing to avoid disturbing others. Available in  
all Dolby Digital modes.  
CENTER  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
Controls the output level of the audio output connector labeled Center.  
Available in all except 2 CH modes (2-CHANNEL, 2 CH BYPASS,  
DTS(-ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL), MONO, 5.1  
MONO, and LIVE! modes.  
CTR WIDTH  
MIN, 1 to 6, MAX  
Adjusts the center image. When set to MIN, the center image is heard  
from just the center speaker. When set to MAX, the center image is  
heard as a “phantom” center image from the front left and right  
speakers. When set on the 1 to 6 scale, the center image is heard in  
various combinations of the front and center speakers. Available in  
Dolby PLII MUSIC and Dolby PLIIx MUSIC modes.  
CENTER DEPTH  
0 to 18  
Adjusts the amount of processing applied to the center channel,  
changing the perceived distance of the center speaker. Higher  
settings increase and lower settings decrease the perceived distance  
of the center speaker from the listening position. Available in  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, and CATHEDRAL modes.  
CUSTOM  
Opens the CUSTOM menu, which is used to compare custom and  
factory-default versions of the selected listening mode and to restore  
the factory default version of the selected listening mode. Available in  
all modes.  
CENTER MIX  
-25 to +5dB  
Indicates the relative center channel level for downmixing. Set this  
parameter to +0dB for film sources and -5dB for music sources.  
Available in 5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS(-ES) 2-CHAN, and 5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
modes.  
CUSTOM VS PRESET  
Allows comparison listening to the custom and factory-default versions  
of the selected listening mode. Refer to page 5-33 for information.  
Available in all modes.  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES  
-127 to +127  
Controls the relative time offset of the center channel. Set this  
parameter to +0 unless the center channel is not properly timed  
and the value of the error is known. Available in 5.1 2-CHANNEL,  
DTS(-ES) 2-CHAN, and 5.1a 2-CHANNEL modes.  
DIMENSION  
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR  
Controls the relative balance of the sound field, which can be useful  
with certain recordings to achieve a more suitable balance among  
all speakers. When set to FRONT, the sound field is balanced toward  
the front of the listening space. When set to NEUTRAL, the sound  
field is balanced at the center of the listening space. When set to  
REAR, the sound field is balanced toward the rear of the listening  
space. Available in Dolby PLII MUSIC and Dolby PLIIx MUSIC modes.  
COMPRESSION  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
Reduces wide volume level changes and increases dialog intelligibility  
at lower listening levels for Dolby Digital input sources. When ON, full  
compression is applied regardless of volume level. When OFF,  
compression is not applied. Set this parameter to AUTO or ON for  
5-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
source is present or when the ES DECODING parameter is set  
to AUTO and a 5.1-channel matrix-encoded or 6.1-channel  
discrete-encoded DTS-ES source is present.  
EARLY RFLX LVL  
-80dB to +12dB, OFF  
Controls the amount of additional early reflections. Available in all  
LIVE! modes.  
This parameter is available in all DTS modes.  
EFFECT LVL  
-12 to +6dB  
EX DECODING  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
Adjusts the amount of effect applied to the listening mode. Available  
in NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, PANORAMA,  
MONO LOGIC, and 5.1 MONO LOGIC modes.  
Controls Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding, which extracts a rear  
channel from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources recorded with or  
without Dolby Digital Surround EX. When ON, Dolby Digital  
Surround EX decoding is engaged for all 5.1-channel Dolby Digital  
sources. When OFF, Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding is disen-  
gaged for all 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources.  
ES DECODING  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
Controls DTS-ES decoding, which extracts a rear channel from  
5.1-channel DTS, 5.1-channel matrix-encoded DTS-ES, and  
6.1-channel discrete-encoded DTS-ES sources. When ON is selected,  
DTS-ES decoding is activated for all DTS-ES sources. When OFF is  
selected, DTS-ES decoding is deactivated for all DTS-ES sources.  
When AUTO is selected, Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding is  
engaged when a flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded  
with Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding is detected. Dolby Digital  
Surround EX decoding is not engaged when a non- flagged  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital source recorded with or without Dolby  
Digital Surround EX encoding is detected.  
When AUTO is selected, DTS-ES decoding is activated when a  
5.1-channel matrix-encoded or a 6.1-channel discrete-encoded  
DTS-ES source is detected. DTS-ES decoding is deactivated when a  
5.1-channel DTS source is detected.  
Note:  
The MC-12 cannot automatically detect Dolby Digital Surround EX  
encoding in non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. A non-flagged  
input source does not identify Dolby Digital Surround EX encoding in the  
input signal.  
DTS-ES listening modes are available when DTS-ES decoding is  
engaged. DTS listening modes are available when DTS-ES decoding is  
not engaged. Refer to the DTS-ES Decoding section that begins on  
page 5-22 for more information.  
Note the following:  
The Dolby DIGITAL EX listening mode is available when Dolby  
Digital Surround EX decoding is engaged. The Dolby DIGITAL  
listening mode is available when Dolby Digital Surround EX  
decoding is not engaged. Refer to the Dolby DIGITAL EX & Dolby  
DIGITAL listening mode descriptions that begin on page 5-19 for  
more information.  
DTS-ES decoding cannot be engaged unless both side and rear  
speakers are present.  
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the  
remote control DTS button while a DTS-ES source is present  
adjusts the ES DECODING parameter, cycling through the  
AUTO, ON, and OFF settings.  
The DTS-ES STATUS menu includes an SB level meter when the  
ES DECODING parameter is set to ON and a 5.1-channel DTS  
5-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS (continued)  
Note the following:  
LFE  
OFF, -30.0 to +012dB  
Controls the output level of the Main Zone audio output connector  
labeled LFE. The OUTPUT LEVELS menu does not include the LFE  
parameter unless an LFE subwoofer is present. Available in All Dolby  
Digital, DTS, and 5.1a modes.  
Dolby Digital Surround EX decoding cannot be engaged unless  
both side and rear speakers are present.  
This parameter is available in 5.1 PLIIx MOV, 5.1 PLIIx MUS, DOLBY  
DIGITAL EX, and DOLBY DIGITAL modes.  
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the  
remote control DOLBY button while a 5.1-channel Dolby  
Digital source is present activates the Dolby DIGITAL EX or  
Dolby DIGITAL listening mode. Subsequent presses adjust the  
EX DECODING parameter, cycling through the AUTO, ON, and  
OFF settings.  
LFE MIX  
-20.0 or -10.0 to +0.0dB  
Controls the output level of LFE information – the 5.1 channel in a  
5.1-channel or 6.1-channel input source – that is sent to the audio  
output labeled Subwoofer. Low frequencies from up to seven other  
channels might be combined with the LFE information to create the  
subwoofer output signal, which significantly increases subwoofer  
output levels.  
FRONT STEERING  
OFF, MSURR, MUSIC, FILM  
Careful adjustment of this parameter allows achievement of proper  
tonal balance and reduces the risk of subwoofer overload. When the  
speaker setup does not include a subwoofer, LFE information is mixed  
into speakers for which the corresponding CUSTOM SETUP menu  
parameter is set to FULL or to the lowest crossover points. Available in  
all Dolby Digital modes except MONO modes (5.1 MONO LOGIC, 5.1  
MONO SURR, 5.1 MONO), all DTS modes, and all 5.1a modes except  
5.1a STANDARD and 5.1a BYPASS modes.  
Adjusts front steering between the front left, front right, and center  
speakers. When set to FILM, maximum front steering is applied to  
the center channel. When set to MUSIC, moderate front steering is  
applied. When set to MSURR, minimum front steering is applied.  
When set to OFF, no front steering is applied. It is recommended  
that you set this parameter to FILM for film and broadcast sources  
and to MUSIC, MSURR or OFF for music sources. Available in L7 TV,  
L7 MUSIC, L7 MUSIC SURR, all 5.1 L7 modes, all DTS L7 modes, and  
all 5.1a L7 modes.  
LISTENER POS  
-127 to +127  
INPUT BALANCE  
L< to <|> to >R  
Compensates for primary listening positions that are not centered  
between the front left and right speakers. Each increment within the  
-127 to +127 parameter range represents about one-third of an inch.  
Refer to the Calibration section that begins on page 5-12 for more  
information. Available in PANORAMA CALIBRATION mode.  
Controls the balance of the selected stereo analog audio input  
connectors, compensating for audio input sources with audible  
channel imbalance. Available in PANORAMA mode.  
5-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
Note:  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
The LISTENER POS parameter range might extend past the location of the  
front left and right speakers.  
Opens the OUTPUT LEVELS menu, which is used to adjust output  
levels for the Main Zone audio output connectors labeled Center,  
Subwoofer L/R, LFE, Side L/R, and Rear L/R. Refer to page 5-32 for  
more information. Available in all except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1  
2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL,  
2CH BYPASS, and LIVE! modes.  
LIVENESS  
30ms to 20.2s  
Depends on the SIZE parameter setting. The LIVENESS parameter  
adjusts the amount of effect recirculation. Higher settings mimic  
more reflective surfaces and increase decay time. Available in  
NIGHTCLUB and CONCERT HALL modes.  
PANORAMA  
ON, OFF  
When set to ON, Dolby PLII MUSIC and Dolby PLIIx MUSIC listening  
modes extend the front stereo image to include surround channel  
signals, which creates a “wraparound” effect with side wall imaging.  
Available in DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC modes.  
LOW FREQ WIDTH  
-25 to +25dB  
Applies low-frequency spatial correction to the input signal. This  
correction is applied to uncorrelated input signals below 60Hz.  
Available in PANORAMA mode.  
Note:  
The PANORAMA parameter within the Dolby PLII MUSIC and Dolby PLIIx  
MUSIC listening modes should not be confused with the separate  
PANORAMA listening mode (page 5-12).  
MASTER LEVEL  
-5 to +5dB  
Adjusts the output level of 2-channel Logic 7-encoded sources.  
Available in 5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS(-ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
modes.  
PRE-DELAY  
1 to 100ms, OFF  
Adjusts delay time between the direct sound and the onset of rever-  
beration. Higher settings make the simulated space sound larger.  
Because some pre-delay is inherent in all source material, you  
should begin with the parameter set to the lowest setting, then  
make adjustments accordingly. Available in NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT  
HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes.  
MID RT  
24ms to 24.3s  
Works with the SIZE parameters to adjust the amount of time  
required for mid-frequency information to decay below 60dB in  
level. The full parameter range might not be available depending  
on the SIZE parameter setting. Available in CHURCH, CATHEDRAL,  
and all LIVE! modes.  
CAUTION!  
Setting the BASS RT, MID RT or SIZE parameters to a high  
value may produce undesirable or damaging audio.  
5-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS (continued)  
RE-EQUALIZER  
ON, OFF  
REVERB LVL  
-80 to +0dB, OFF  
Simulates high-frequency rolloffs that occur in movie theaters.  
When set to ON, the MC-12 applies a high-frequency filter. When  
set to OFF, the MC-12 does not apply a high-frequency filter. It is  
recommended that you set this parameter to ON for film sources,  
as many films are mixed for movie theaters and might sound too  
bright when played back in home theaters without re-equalization.  
Available in L7 FILM, L7 TV, DPLII + THX, DPLIIx + THX, 5.1 L7 FILM,  
5.1 L7 TV, THX ULTRA2, THX SurEX, THX, DTS (ES) L7 FILM, DTS (ES)  
THX ULTRA2, DTS (ES) THX, 5.1a L7 FILM, 5.1a THX ULTRA2, 5.1a  
THX SurEX, 5.1a THX modes.  
Controls the amount of added reverb. Available in all LIVE! modes.  
ROLLOFF  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
Simulates the absorption of high frequencies in a real space. It is  
recommended that you begin with a low setting to simulate  
high-frequency absorptive spaces. Available in NIGHTCLUB,  
CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL and all LIVE! modes.  
SHAPE  
0 TO 4  
Controls the buildup of the energy that most audibly creates the  
sound of a real room. SHAPE and SPREAD work together – if either is  
set to zero, the other has no effect. Available in all LIVE! modes.  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
Increases the perceived depth of the listening space by delaying the  
arrival time of rear speaker signals. It is recommended that you  
increase the setting when using side and rear speakers that are  
located close together or when a greater sense of depth is desired in  
the listening space. Available in All Logic 7 modes and PANORAMA  
mode.  
SIDE L/R  
-30 to +12dB, OFF  
Controls the level of the Side L/R audio output connectors in the  
Main Zone. Available in all except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1  
2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH  
BYPASS, and LIVE! modes.  
REAR L/R  
-30 to +12dB, OFF  
Controls the output level of the audio output connector labeled  
Rear L/R. Available in all except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1  
2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH  
BYPASS, and LIVE! modes.  
SIZE  
4 to 20 or 30m  
Adjusts the length of the listening space within a 4m to 20m or  
30m range (depending on the listening mode). Increase the size of  
the space to increase the reverb effect. Available in NIGHTCLUB,  
CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes.  
RESET MODE  
Restores the factory-default version of the selected listening mode,  
restoring all listening mode menu parameters to their  
factory-default settings. Available in all modes.  
CAUTION!  
Setting the BASS RT, MID RT and SIZE parameters to a  
high value may produce undesirable or damaging audio.  
5-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
SOUND STAGE  
FRONT, NEUTRAL, REAR  
SPEECH DETECT  
ON, OFF  
Dynamically controls the relative balance of the audio output  
connectors. When set to FRONT, Side L/R and Rear L/R output levels  
are attenuated by 6dB, shifting the perceived balance of the sound  
field to the front of the listening space. When set to NEUTRAL, Side L/R  
and Rear L/R output levels are slightly attenuated by 3dB, shifting the  
perceived balance of the sound field to the center of the listening  
space. When set to REAR, Side L/R and Rear L/R output levels are not  
attenuated, preserving the intended balance of the sound field.  
Available in all Logic 7 modes.  
Distinguishes monaural speech from other input sources. When set to  
ON, effects are lowered to minimize interference and unnatural echo  
in monaural speech. When stereo input sources are present, the front  
left and right channels are independently used as inputs for ambience  
synthesis. When strong monaural speech is present in the input source,  
the monaural component of the ambience effect is reduced and the  
stereo component of the effect is increased. When set to OFF, the  
amount of ambience synthesis is dynamically controlled. Available in  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, and CATHEDRAL modes.  
SPREAD  
0 to 100%  
SOURCE  
RIGHT, LEFT & RIGHT, LEFT  
Controls the timing between the initial reflections that most audibly  
create the sound of a real room. SHAPE and SPREAD work together; if  
either is set to 0, the other has no effect. Available in all LIVE! modes.  
Controls the perceived direction of the PANORAMA listening mode  
external calibration source signal. When RIGHT is selected, the  
sound is perceived to come from the right of the primary listening  
position. When LEFT is selected, the sound is perceived to come  
from the left of the primary listening position. When LEFT & RIGHT  
is selected, the sound is perceived to come from all around the  
primary listening position. Refer to the Calibration section that  
begins on page 5-13 for more information about the SOURCE  
parameter. Available in PANORAMA CALIBRATION.  
SUB L/R & SUB L/R LVL  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
Controls the output level of the Main Zone audio output  
connectors labeled Subwoofer L/R. The SUB L/R parameter appears  
on the listening mode OUTPUT LEVELS menu. The SUB L/R LVL  
parameter appears on listening mode menus when the listening  
mode does not accommodate multi-channel output signals.  
Available in all except LIVE! modes.  
Note:  
The SOURCE parameter controls the perceived direction of the sound,  
although both the front left and right speakers generate the external  
calibration source signal.  
SURR ROLLOFF  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
Applies high-frequency attenuation control to the audio output  
connectors labeled Side L/R and Rear L/R. This filter is only applied to  
output signals generated by the MC-12. Available in all Logic 7 modes.  
SPEAKER ANGLE  
10 to 90deg  
Compensates for a wide or narrow speaker angle relative to the  
primary listening position. Select the setting closest to the angle  
between the front left and right speakers and the primary listening  
position. Refer to the Calibration section that begins on page 5-13  
for more information about the SPEAKER ANGLE parameter.  
Available in PANORAMA CALIBRATION.  
5-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
LISTENING MODE MENU OPTION & PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS (continued)  
page 5-26, or the 5.1a THX ULTRA2, 5.1a THX SurEX, & 5.1a THX  
listening mode descriptions that begin on page 5-29 for more  
information.  
SURROUND DLY  
0 to 15ms  
Increases the perceived depth of the listening space by delaying the  
arrival time of signals from the side and rear speakers. It is recom-  
mended that you increase the setting when a greater sense of  
depth is desired in the listening space. Available in DPLII MUSIC and  
DPLIIx MUSIC modes.  
Note the following:  
The SURROUND EX parameter AUTO setting is not available for  
the 5.1a THX listening modes.  
SURROUND EX  
AUTO, ON, OFF  
Toggling the SURROUND EX parameter setting produces low  
level clicks in the front speakers.  
Controls the THX Surround EX decoding feature, which can be used to  
extract a rear channel from 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. When  
ON is selected, THX Surround EX decoding is engaged for all  
5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. When OFF is selected, THX  
Surround EX decoding is not engaged for all 5.1-channel Dolby Digital  
sources. Available in THX ULTRA2, THX SurEX, and THX modes.  
THX Surround EX decoding cannot be engaged unless both  
side and rear speakers are present.  
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the  
remote control THX button while a 5.1-channel Dolby Digital  
source is present activates the 5.1 THX ULTRA2, 5.1 THX SurEX,  
or 5.1 THX listening mode. Subsequent presses adjust the  
SURROUND EX parameter, cycling through the AUTO, ON,  
and OFF settings.  
When AUTO is selected, THX Surround EX decoding is engaged  
when a flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source with THX  
Surround EX encoding is detected. THX Surround EX decoding is  
not engaged when a non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital source  
with or without THX Surround EX encoding is detected.  
When the Shift command bank is activated, pressing the  
remote control THX button while a 5.1-channel analog source  
is present activates the 5.1a THX ULTRA2, 5.1a THX SurEX, or  
5.1a THX listening mode. Subsequent presses toggle the  
SURROUND EX parameter between the ON and OFF settings.  
Note:  
The MC-12 cannot automatically detect THX Surround EX encoding in  
non-flagged 5.1-channel Dolby Digital sources. A non-flagged input  
source does not include information in the input signal that identifies THX  
Surround EX encoding.  
SURROUND MIX  
-5 to +5dB  
Controls the relative level of surround channel information sent to the  
audio output connectors labeled Front L/R. It is recommended that  
you set this parameter to +2dB or +3dB for all input sources. Available  
in 5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, and 5.1a 2-CHANNEL modes.  
THX Surround EX listening modes are available when Dolby Digital  
Surround EX decoding is engaged. THX or THX ULTRA2 listening  
modes are available when THX Surround EX decoding is not  
engaged. Refer to the 5.1 THX ULTRA2, 5.1 THX SurEX, & 5.1 THX  
listening mode descriptions that begin on page 5-18, the DTS THX  
ULTRA2 & DTS-ES THX listening mode descriptions that begin on  
5-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
and consequently can actually shorten the reverb time. Available in  
all LIVE! modes.  
TREB CUT RT  
500Hz to 20kHz  
Sets the frequency above which high frequencies are rolled off in  
the reverberated signal, causing reverberated signals to grow  
progressively darker. This results in a more natural sound because it  
simulates the effect of air absorption in a real hall. Setting this  
parameter to a low frequency dampens the audio as it recirculates,  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
+6.0dB, +3.0dB, +0.0dB  
Controls the level of dialog boost in the audio output connector  
labeled Center. Increase this setting to improve dialog intelligibility,  
particularly at lower volume levels. Available in all Logic 7 modes.  
MODE – PARAMETER RELATIONSHIPS  
The following table lists each parameter and the modes in which it is used.  
The parameter...  
Is used in these modes  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
ACADEMY FILTER  
AUTO AZIMUTH  
BASS CONTENT  
BASS ENHANCE  
BASS RT  
All L7 modes  
MONO LOGIC and 5.1 MONO LOGIC  
L7 FILM and L7 TV  
PANORAMA  
All L7 modes  
CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes  
All LIVE! modes  
BASS XOVER  
CALIBRATION  
CENTER  
PANORAMA  
All except 2 CH modes (2-CHANNEL, 2 CH BYPASS, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL),  
MONO, 5.1 MONO, and LIVE! modes  
5-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
The parameter...  
Is used in these modes  
CENTER DEPTH  
CENTER MIX  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES  
COMPRESSION  
CTR WIDTH  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL  
5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
All Dolby Digital modes  
DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC  
CUSTOM  
All modes  
CUSTOM VS PRESET  
DIFFUSION  
All modes  
All LIVE! modes  
DIMENSION  
EARLY RFLX LVL  
EFFECT LVL  
DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC  
All LIVE! modes  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, PANORAMA, MONO LOGIC, and 5.1 MONO LOGIC  
ES DECODING  
EX DECODING  
FRONT STEERING  
INPUT BALANCE  
LFE  
All DTS modes  
5.1 PLIIx MOV, 5.1 PLIIx MUS, DOLBY DIGITAL EX, and DOLBY DIGITAL  
L7 TV, L7 MUSIC, L7 MUSIC SURR, all 5.1 L7 modes, all DTS L7 modes, and all 5.1a L7 modes  
PANORAMA  
All Dolby Digital, DTS, and 5.1a modes  
LFE MIX  
All Dolby Digital modes except MONO modes (5.1 MONO LOGIC, 5.1 MONO SURR, 5.1 MONO), all DTS  
modes, and all 5.1a modes except 5.1a STANDARD and 5.1a BYPASS  
LISTENER POS  
5-46  
PANORAMA CALIBRATION  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Mode Adjust  
The parameter...  
Is used in these modes  
LIVENESS  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL  
LOW FREQ WIDTH  
MASTER LEVEL  
MID RT  
PANORAMA  
5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
All except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH BYPASS,  
and LIVE! modes  
PANORAMA  
PRE-DELAY  
DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes  
RE-EQUALIZER  
L7 FILM, L7 TV, DPLII + THX, DPLIIx + THX, 5.1 L7 FILM, 5.1 L7 TV, THX ULTRA2, THX SurEX, THX, DTS (ES) L7  
FILM, DTS (ES) THX ULTRA2, DTS (ES) THX, 5.1a L7 FILM, 5.1a THX ULTRA2, 5.1a THX SurEX, 5.1a THX  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
REAR L/R  
All L7 modes and PANORAMA  
All except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH BYPASS,  
and LIVE! modes  
RESET MODE  
REVERB LVL  
ROLLOFF  
SHAPE  
All modes  
All LIVE! modes  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes  
All LIVE! modes  
SIDE L/R  
All except 2-CHANNEL, MONO, 5.1 2-CHANNEL, 5.1 MONO, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL, 2CH BYPASS,  
and LIVE! modes  
SIZE  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, CATHEDRAL, and all LIVE! modes  
All L7 modes  
SOUND STAGE  
5-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mode Adjust  
Lexicon  
The parameter...  
Is used in these modes  
SOURCE  
PANORAMA CALIBRATION  
PANORAMA CALIBRATION  
NIGHTCLUB, CONCERT HALL, CHURCH, and CATHEDRAL  
All LIVE! modes  
SPEAKER ANGLE  
SPEECH DETECT  
SPREAD  
SUB L/R & SUB L/R LVL  
SURR ROLLOFF  
SURROUND DLY  
SURROUND EX  
SURROUND MIX  
TREB CUT RT  
All except LIVE! modes  
All L7 modes  
DPLII MUSIC and DPLIIx MUSIC  
THX ULTRA2, THX SurEX, THX  
5.1 2-CHANNEL, DTS (ES) 2-CHAN, 5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
All LIVE! modes  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
All L7 modes  
5-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
Troubleshooting & Maintenance  
Troubleshooting..........................................................................6-2  
Routine Maintenance..................................................................6-3  
Restoring Factory-default Settings ...............................................6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting & Maintenance  
Lexicon  
2. Make sure volume level is audible. Volume level can be  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
increased with the front panel volume knob or the remote con-  
trol VOL + and – buttons.  
The MC-12 does not power on.  
3. Make sure audio has not been muted. The message “MUTE  
ON” or “FULL MUTE ON” will appear in the on-screen and  
front panel displays when audio has been muted. To deactivate  
mute, press the Mute button or adjust the volume level.  
1. Make sure the rear panel power switch is set to the I (“on”)  
position.  
2. Attempt to power on the MC-12 with the front panel Standby  
4. Check the INPUT SETUP menu DIGITAL IN and ANALOG IN  
parameters to ensure the appropriate audio connector is assigned  
to the selected input.  
button and remote control On button.  
3. Examine the power cord to ensure a good connection between  
the rear panel AC input connector and the wall outlet.  
5. Make sure the MC-12 is receiving an audio signal. To do this,  
follow the instructions that begin on page 2-20 to open the  
STATUS menu for the current input source.  
4. Check the electrical circuit and breaker.  
6. Make sure all associated power amplifiers are powered on.  
The remote control does not work.  
1. Eliminate obstructions between the remote control and the  
front panel IR receiver. When the MC-12 is not using the rear  
panel IR IN connector, the remote control must be in  
line-of-sight with the front panel IR receiver for proper opera-  
tion. The remote control might also become unreliable if  
strong sunlight or fluorescent light is shining on the IR receiver.  
Dialog sounds muffled.  
If the speaker setup does not include a center speaker, make sure a  
custom – as opposed to a THX – speaker setup is selected. Then,  
make sure the CUSTOM SETUP menu CENTER parameter is set to  
NONE.  
2. Make sure the remote control batteries are correctly inserted  
with the proper polarity.  
A humming sound is present in the audio.  
3. Replace the remote control batteries. When the batteries are  
low on power, the remote control enters a low-voltage condi-  
tion that prevents it from operating the MC-12.  
1. If a cable TV connection is present, disconnect the cable from  
the wall outlet. If this eliminates the humming sound, a ground  
loop isolation device is required. Contact your dealer or the  
cable provider for assistance.  
The MC-12 is powered on, but there is no audio.  
2. Disconnect components one at a time to isolate the problem.  
Once the problem is identified, make sure the associated com-  
ponent is properly grounded and connected to the same elec-  
trical circuit as the MC-12.  
1. Examine the audio cables to ensure a good connection  
between the MC-12 and all associated power amplifiers.  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Troubleshooting & Maintenance  
The MC-12 is powered on, but there is no video.  
2. Use the MC-12 configuration tool to download the current  
MC-12 configuration to a personal computer (PC) or docu-  
ment all user-defined settings on the installation worksheet  
that begins on page A-20. Then, follow the instructions on  
page 6-4 to restore factory-default settings.  
1. Examine the video cables – particularly the S-video cables – to  
ensure a good connection to the associated component.  
2. Check the INPUT SETUP menu VIDEO IN and COMPONENT IN  
parameters to ensure the appropriate video connector is  
assigned to the selected input.  
3. Contact an authorized Lexicon dealer.  
4. Contact Lexicon customer service at 781-280-0300 or  
www.lexicon.com.  
RF interference is present in the audio or video.  
Note:  
1. Make sure the MC-12 is not positioned near unshielded TV or  
FM antennas, cable TV decoders, and other RF-emitting  
devices.  
Visit the knowledgebase at http://www.lexicon.com/kbase for  
answers to frequently asked questions and additional trouble-  
shooting information.  
2. Replace unshielded cables with shielded cables wherever possible.  
The MC-12 is exhibiting erratic behavior.  
ROUTINE MAINTENANCE  
1. Set the rear panel power switch to the c(“off”) position. Wait  
10 seconds. Then, set the rear panel power switch to the  
| (“on”) position.  
The bulleted items below describe routine maintenance that  
should be performed on a periodic basis.  
2. Use the MC-12 configuration tool to download the current  
MC-12 configuration to a personal computer (PC) or docu-  
ment all user-defined settings on the installation worksheet  
that begins on page A-20. Then, follow the instructions on the  
next page to restore factory-default settings.  
Clean the MC-12 exterior surface with a soft, lint-free cloth. Do  
not use alcohol, benzene, acetone-based cleaners, or strong  
commercial cleaners. Do not use a cloth made with steel wool  
or metal polish. If the MC-12 is exposed to a dusty environ-  
ment, a low-pressure blower can be used to remove dust from  
its exterior surface.  
Replace the remote control batteries as needed. The remote  
control requires two AA batteries. When these batteries are low  
on power, the remote control enters a low-voltage condition  
that prevents it from operating the MC-12. Normal operation  
will resume when new batteries are installed.  
If all else fails . . .  
1. Set the rear panel power switch to the c(“off”) position. Wait  
10 seconds. Then, set the rear panel power switch to the  
| (“on”) position.  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting & Maintenance  
Lexicon  
5. Press the and arrow buttons to highlight the desired  
option.  
RESTORING FACTORY-DEFAULT SETTINGS  
When factory-default settings are restored, all parameters and  
user-defined values are restored to their factory-default settings.  
Before restoring factory-default settings, you should record all  
user-defined settings.  
Highlight RESTORE DEFAULTS to restore factory default settings.  
Highlight EXIT to close the FACTORY SETTINGS menu without  
restoring factory-default settings.  
6. When the desired option is highlighted, press the arrow  
button to select this option.  
FACTORY SETTINGS  
FACTORY SETTINGS  
If the RESTORE DEFAULTS option was selected, the FAC-  
TORY SETTINGS message shown on the previous page will  
appear on the on-screen and front panel displays. When this  
message appears, press a front panel or remote control but-  
ton to restart the MC-12.  
EXIT  
HAVE BEEN RESTORED  
PRESS ANY KEY  
TO RESTART  
RESTORE DEFAULTS  
To restore factory-default settings:  
If the EXIT option is selected, the FACTORY SETTINGS menu  
will close and the two-line status will open on the on-screen  
and front panel displays  
1. Select one of the following options to record user defined settings:  
Use the Configuration Tool to download current MC-12 set-  
tings to a personal computer (PC). The configuration tool is  
available at www.lexicon.com/mc12/downloads. asp.  
Record user-defined settings on the installation worksheet  
2. If applicable, press the Standby Button to activate standby  
mode.  
3. When standby mode is activated, press the Standby Button  
to deactivate standby mode.  
4. After the Standby Button is pressed, quickly press and hold the  
Mute button until the FACTORY SETTINGS menu shown above  
opens on the on-screen and front panel displays.  
Note:  
The Mute button must be pressed within 2 seconds of deac-  
tivating standby mode. Otherwise, the "MUTE ON" message  
will appear on the on-screen and front panel displays. If this  
occurs, too much time has passed. Begin again with step 2.  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
A
Appendix  
Specifications............................................................................. A-2  
Declaration of Conformity.......................................................... A-4  
Menu Tree ................................................................................. A-5  
Installation Worksheet ............................................................. A-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix  
Lexicon  
SPECIFICATIONS  
Main Zone Audio Performance  
Audio Input & Output Connectors  
Output Level  
• 150mVrms typical, 6Vrms maximum (RCA connectors)  
• 300mVrms typical, 12Vrms maximum (XLR connectors,  
MC-12 Balanced only)  
• Maximum value with full-scale input signal and volume at  
+12dB  
Analog Audio Inputs  
Digital Audio Inputs  
• 8 stereo (RCA) or 5 stereo and one 5.1-channel connectors  
• 6 S/PDIF coaxial (RCA), 6 S/PDIF optical (5 TosLink and 1  
optical mini jack), and 1 AES/EBU (XLR) connectors  
• Coaxial and optical input connectors conform to IEC-  
958, S/PDIF standards  
• Accepts 44.1, 48, 88.2 and 96kHz sample rates  
• Accepts 16-24 bits PCM audio, Dolby Digital, DTS and  
DTS-ES discrete data formats  
Output Impedance  
• 100in parallel with 150pF (RCA connectors)  
• 50in parallel with 150pF (XLR connectors, MC-12 Bal-  
anced only)  
Main Zone Audio  
Outputs  
• 12 unbalanced (RCA) and 12 balanced (XLR, MC-12  
Balanced only) connectors for Front L/R, Center, LFE,  
Subwoofer L/R, Side L/R, and Rear L/R, and Auxiliary L/R  
Zone 2 & Record Zone Audio Performance  
Zone 2 Audio Outputs • 2 unbalanced (RCA, 1 fixed and 1 variable output level)  
stereo connectors and 1 balanced stereo connector  
A/D Conversion  
• 24-bit, 44.1 to 96kHz, dual-bit Σarchitecture (Record  
Zone only)  
(XLR, variable output level, MC-12 Balanced only)  
D/A Conversion  
• 24-bit, 44.1 to 192kHz, multi-bit ∆Σ architecture  
Record Zone Audio  
Outputs  
• 2 unbalanced (RCA, 1 fixed and 1 variable output level)  
stereo connectors  
• 1 S/PDIF coaxial (RDA) and 1 S/PDIF optical (TosLink)  
connector (in parallel)  
Frequency Response • 10Hz to 20kHz, +0.1dB/-0.25dB, -0.75dB at 40kHz, refer-  
ence 1kHz  
THD + Noise  
• Below 0.005% at 1kHz, maximum output level  
• 105dB minimum, 108dB typical, 22kHz bandwidth  
Dynamic Range  
Signal-to-Noise Ratio • 105dB minimum, 108dB typical, 22kHz bandwidth  
Main Zone Audio Performance  
Input Sensitivity  
Input Impedance  
Output Level  
• 200mVrms (4Vrms for maximum output level)  
A/D Conversion  
D/A Conversion  
• 24-bit, 96kHz, dual-bit Σarchitecture  
• 24-bit, 44.1 to 192kHz, multi-bit ∆Σ architecture  
• 100kin parallel with 150pF  
• 200mVrms typical, 4Vrms maximum (RCA connectors)  
• 400mVrms typical, 8Vrms maximum (XLR connectors,  
Zone 2 only, MC-12 Balanced only)  
• Maximum value with full-scale input signal and volume at  
0dB  
Frequency Response • 10Hz to 20kHz, +0.1dB/-0.25dB, -0.75dB at 40kHz, refer-  
ence 1kHz  
THD + Noise  
• Below 0.003% at 1kHz, maximum output level  
• 108dB minimum, 111dB typical, 22kHz bandwidth  
Dynamic Range  
Output Impedance  
• 100in parallel with 150pF (RCA connectors)  
• 50in parallel with 150pF (XLR connectors, Zone 2 only,  
MC-12 Balanced only)  
Signal-to-Noise Ratio • 108dB minimum, 111dB typical, 22kHz bandwidth  
Input Sensitivity  
• 200mVrms (2Vrms for maximum output level) at 0dB  
input gain  
Input Impedance  
• 100kin parallel with 150pF  
A-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MC-12  
Appendix  
Video Input & Output Connectors  
Microphone Input Connectors  
Video Inputs  
• 5 composite (RCA), 8 S-video, and 4 component video (3  
RCA and 1 BNC))  
Inputs  
• 4 3.5 miniature phone jacks  
• 10mVrms (400mV maximum input level)  
Input Sensitivity  
Input Impedence  
Video Outputs  
• 4 composite (RCA, 2 monitor and 2 Record Zone), 2 S-  
video (2 monitor and 2 Record Zone), and 1 component  
(BNC)  
• 20k(accepts balanced or unbalanced input signals)  
Other  
Composite & S-video Performance  
Trigger Outputs  
• 1 power on/off and 1 programmable connector on  
detachable screw terminals (+12 VDC, 0.5 amps each)  
Compatibility  
Switching  
• NTSC, PAL, and SECAM  
• Active  
RS-232 Serial Input/ • 2 9-pin D-sub connectors  
Output  
Output Level  
Impedance  
• 1.0V peak-to-peak  
Power Requirements • 90-250 VAC, 50-60Hz, 60W (universal line input), detach-  
able power cord  
• 75Ω  
Input Return Loss  
Differential Gain  
Differential Phase  
Bandwidth  
• >40dB  
• <0.5%  
• <0.5°  
MC-12  
Dimensions &  
Weight  
• Height (with feet): 5.2 inches (132mm)  
• Width: 17.3 inches (440mm)  
• Depth: 14.85 inches (377mm)  
• Weight: 36lbs (16.4kg)  
• >25MHz  
• <0.3%  
MC-12 Balanced  
Dimensions &  
Weight  
• Height (with feet): 6.63 inches (169mm)  
• Width: 17.3 inches (440mm)  
• Depth: 14.85 inches (377mm)  
• Weight: 45lbs (20.5kg)  
K Factor  
Gain  
0.15dB  
Signal-to-Noise Ratio • >70dB  
Rack Mounting  
Environment  
• Optional brackets are available for installation in a stan-  
dard 19" equipment rack (2 rack units required for MC-  
12; 3 rack units required for MC-12 Balanced.)  
Frequency Response • 10Hz to 10MHz + 0.1/-0.3dB  
• Operating Temperature: 0° to 35°C (32° to 95°F)  
• Storage Temperature: -30° to 75°C (-22° to 167°F)  
• Relative Humidity: 95% maximum without condensation  
Component Video Performance  
Compatibility  
Switching  
• 3-channel (Y, Pr, Pb), format-independent  
Remote Control  
• Hand-held, backlit infrared remote control unit  
• Requires 2 AA batteries (Alkaline batteries recommended)  
• Passive  
• 75Ω  
Impedence  
Insertion Loss  
Bandwidth  
• <3dB  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
• >300MHz  
A-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY  
Lexicon  
Application of Council Directive(s):  
89/336/EEC and 93/68/EEC  
Standard(s) to Which Conformity is Declared:  
EN55022:1998, EN55024:1998, EN61000-3-2: 2000,  
EN61000-3-3:2000, and EN60065: 1998  
Manufacturer:  
Harman Specialty Group  
3 Oak Park  
Bedford, MA 01730-1413 USA  
The equipment identified here conforms to the Directive(s)  
and Standard(s) specified above.  
Type of Equipment: Digital Controller  
Model:  
Date:  
Lexicon MC-12  
June 2001  
Harman Specialty Group  
Vice President of Engineering  
3 Oak Park  
Bedford, MA 01730-1413 USA  
Tel: 781-280-0300  
Fax: 781-280-0490  
A-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MC-12  
Appendix  
MENU TREE  
TRIGGER SETUP  
TRIGGER SETUP  
Selecting SETUPTRIGGERS prompts the  
selection of a trigger output connector.  
Selecting a connector opens the TRIGGER  
SETUP menu Shown at the far right. The  
parameters on the left side of the TRIGGER  
SETUP menu are identical regardless of the  
selected connector. The TRIGGER SETUP  
menu indicates factory-default parameter  
settings for both connectors.  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
REMOTE ONLY  
DVD1  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
5.1 MONO SURR  
5.1 MONO  
FILM  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
ZONE2 INPUTS  
RECORD INPUTS  
FILM  
TV  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
PLIIx +  
PLIIx MOV  
PLIIx MUS  
PLII +  
PLII MOVIE  
PLII MUSIC  
PL +  
PRO LOGIC  
+
MUSIC  
TRIGGER SETUP  
TRIGGER 1  
TRIGGER 2  
REMOTE  
REMOTE  
MUSIC  
2-CHAN  
5.1a FILM  
5.1a MUSIC  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
5.1a  
5.1a  
SurEX  
MUSIC  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
5.1a BYPASS  
2CH BYPASS  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
!CAUTION!  
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS  
LIVE! LARGE  
INPUT SETUP  
VOLUME CONTROL SETUP  
MAIN POWER ON -30dB  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
continued on page A-14  
8 STEREO INPUTS  
OR  
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
MUTE LEVEL  
ZONE PWR ON  
REC PWR ON  
MAX VOLUME  
-30dB  
-30dB  
-30dB  
+12dB  
LOCK OPTIONS  
MODES  
AUDIO CNTRL UNLOCKED  
SETUP  
UNLOCKED  
8 STEREO INPUTS  
FOR REAR PANEL CFG  
UNLOCKED  
VCR  
CD  
LAST LVL, -80 to +12dB  
CIN  
MUSIC  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
5 ST. & (1) 5.1 ANLG  
FOR REAR PANEL CFG  
NIGHTCLUB  
CONCERT HHALL  
CHURCH  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
2-CH SURROUND  
2-CHANNEL  
MONO LOGIC  
MONO SURROUND  
MONO  
5.1 FILM  
5.1 TV  
5.1 MUSIC  
SurEX  
-10dB  
-20dB  
-30dB  
LOCKED  
UNLOCKED  
-40dB  
FULL MUTE  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
continued on page A-6  
ALWAYS ON  
100%  
STATUS  
BRIGHTNESS  
SPEAKER SETUP  
100%  
75%  
50%  
25%  
SETUP CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
DISPLAY SETUP  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
MUSIC  
MANUAL  
OFF  
OFF  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
DIGITAL EX  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
ALWAYS ON  
2 SECONDS  
ALWAYS OFF  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
STATUS  
POSITION  
2 SECONDS  
TOP  
continued on page A-9  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
MC-12  
FORMAT  
NTSC  
TOP  
CENTER  
BOTTOM  
ON  
ON  
BACKGROUND  
REMOTE STATE  
OFF, 1 to 60ms  
BUTTONS TO EDIT  
UP TO 20 CHARACTERS  
BUTTON TO ADVANCE  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
SECAM  
PAL  
NTSC  
ON  
OFF  
A-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix  
Lexicon  
MENU TREE (continued)  
Selecting SETUP INPUTS prompts the selection of the  
desired input (for example, DVD1). Selecting an input  
opens the corresponding INPUT SETUP menu shown  
below. The parameters on the left side of the INPUT SETUP  
menus are identical regardless of which input is selected.  
The parameter settings on the right side are adjustable.  
Default parameter settings differ from input to input. The  
INPUT SETUP menus shown below indicate default  
parameter settings for each input.  
SETUP  
MAIN MENU  
INPUT SETUP  
INPUT SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
LD INPUT SETUP  
SAT INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
CD INPUT SETUP  
GAME INPUT SETUP  
TUNER INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
DVD1  
COAX-1  
NONE  
NAME  
LD  
COAX-3  
ANALOG-1  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-3  
1
SAT  
NAME  
CD  
COAX-4  
NONE  
NAME  
GAME  
NAME  
TUNER  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
OPTICAL-2  
ANALOG-3  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-5  
4
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
OPTICAL-4  
ANALOG-6  
AUTO  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
NONE  
ANALOG-8  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-1  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-2  
NONE  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
1
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
1
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
1
FILM  
FILM  
TV  
MUSIC  
FILM  
MUSIC  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
D
5.1 TV  
FILM  
D
5.1 MUSIC  
MUSIC  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
D
5.1 MUSIC  
MUSIC  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
FILM  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
ANLG  
ANLG  
ANLG  
ANLG  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
ANLG  
ANLG  
RECORD IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD ADVANCED  
PVR INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
DVD2 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
VCR INPUT SETUP  
TAPE INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
AUX INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
TV INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
PVR  
DVD2  
NAME  
VCR  
TAPE  
AUX  
TV  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
OPTICAL-3  
ANALOG-5  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-7  
1
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-2  
NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
OPTICAL-5  
ANALOG-7  
AUTO  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
OPTICAL-6  
NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
OPTICAL-1  
ANALOG-2  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-4  
3
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
ANALOG-4  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-6  
1
AUTO  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-2  
2
NONE  
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-3  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
1
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
1
TV  
FILM  
FILM  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
TV  
TV  
FILM  
D
5.1 TV  
FILM  
D
5.1 FILM  
FILM  
D
5.1  
FILM  
FILM  
FILM  
D
5.1 MUSIC  
MUSIC  
D
5.1 MUSIC  
MUSIC  
D
5.1  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
LIVE! MED  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
FILM  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
ANLG  
ANLG  
ANLG  
ANLG  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
ANLG  
ANLG  
RECORD IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD ADVANCED  
RECORD ADVANCED  
A-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Appendix  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 INPUT SETUP  
NAME  
Selecting an INPUT SETUP menu item opens the  
corresponding menu shown below. These menus  
are identical regardless of which input is selected.  
The MAIN ADV and RECORD ADV menus shown  
on the next page indicate factory-default parame-  
ter settings for each input.  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
DVD1  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
COAX-1  
NONE  
AUTO  
S-VIDEO-1  
1
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
FILM  
FILM  
FILM  
D
5.1  
DIGITAL  
ANLG  
DMIX  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a FILM  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DVD1  
D MODE  
RECORD IN  
AUTO  
OFF  
RECORD ADVANCED  
5.1 FILM  
5.1 TV  
5.1 MUSIC  
DIGITAL  
ANALOG  
AUTO  
DVD1 ANALOG IN  
DVD1 2-CH MODE  
DVD1 VIDEO IN  
DVD1 INPUT NAME  
COMPOSITE-1  
COMPOSITE-2  
COMPOSITE-3  
COMPOSITE-4  
COMPOSITE-5  
S-VIDEO-1  
S-VIDEO-2  
S-VIDEO-3  
S-VIDEO-4  
S-VIDEO-5  
S-VIDEO-6  
S-VIDEO-7  
S-VIDEO-8  
NONE  
DIGITAL  
ANALOG-1  
ANALOG-2  
ANALOG-3  
ANALOG-4  
ANALOG-5  
ANALOG-6  
ANALOG-7 5.1 ANLG (6-8)  
ANALOG-8  
NONE  
EDIT INPUT NAME  
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME  
FILM  
TV  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
PLII +  
PLII MOVIE  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
5.1 MONO SURR  
5.1 MONO  
DVD1 MAIN ADV  
DIGITAL  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
PRESS MENU TO  
RESTORE INPUT NAME  
USE LAST  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
PLII MUSIC  
EDIT INPUT NAME  
DVD1  
OFF  
COMPONENT OSD  
PL +  
DVD1  
MODE  
FILM  
PRO LOGIC  
NIGHTCLUB  
CONCERT HALL  
CHURCH  
LIVE!  
ON  
OFF  
MUSIC  
BUTTONS TO EDIT  
UP TO 8 CHARACTERS  
BUTTON TO ADVANCE  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
2-CH SURROUND  
2-CHANNEL  
MONO LOGIC  
MONO SURROUND  
MONO  
DVD1 RECORD ADV  
DVD1 ANLG IN LVL  
2-CHAN  
USE LAST  
DIGITAL  
ANLG IN LVL  
ON  
+0.dB  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
DVD1 DIGITAL IN  
OFF  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
44.1kHz  
ENABLED  
COAX-1  
COAX-2  
COAX-3  
COAX-4  
COAX-5  
COAX-6  
OPTICAL-1  
OPTICAL-2  
OPTICAL-3  
OPTICAL-4  
OPTICAL-5  
OPTICAL-6  
AES/EBU  
NONE  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
DVD1 5.1a MODE  
DVD1 COMPONENT  
5.1a FILM  
5.1a MUSIC  
5.1a  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a 2-CHAN  
USE LAST  
COMPONENT-1  
COMPONENT-2  
COMPONENT-3  
COMPONENT-4  
AUTO GAIN  
+0.0dB  
L
R
dB  
BLOCKED  
ENABLED  
USE LAST  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
INPUT  
96kHz  
-45  
88.2kHz  
48kHz  
DVD1 MIC MODE  
-18 to +12dB  
44.1kHz  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
LIVE! LARGE  
USE LAST  
ON  
OFF  
-18 to +12dB  
A-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Lexicon  
MENU TREE (continued)  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
The MAIN ADV and RECORD ADV menus indicate  
factory-default parameter settings for each input.  
INPUT SETUP  
CD INPUT SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
NAME  
CD  
COAX-4  
NONE  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
AUTO  
VIDEO IN COMPOSITE-1  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
1
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
MUSIC  
D
5.1 MUSIC  
MUSIC  
5.1a  
MIC  
5.1a  
FILM  
LIVE! MED  
MAIN ADVANCED  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
DVD1 MAIN ADV  
SAT MAIN ADV  
GAME MAIN ADV  
DIGITAL  
OFF  
AUTO  
AUTO  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
AUTO  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
DVD1 RECORD ADV  
SAT RECORD ADV  
GAME RECORD ADV  
+OdB  
OFF  
+OdB  
OFF  
44.1kHz  
+OdB  
OFF  
ANLG IN LVL  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
ON  
OFF  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
44.1kHz  
44.1kHz  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
OFF  
OFF  
ENABLED  
ENABLED  
ENABLED  
DVD2 MAIN ADV  
VCR MAIN ADV  
TAPE MAIN ADV  
DIGITAL  
OFF  
ANALOG  
OFF  
AUTO  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
DVD2 RECORD ADV  
VCR RECORD ADV  
TAPE RECORD ADV  
+OdB  
OFF  
+OdB  
OFF  
44.1kHz  
+OdB  
OFF  
ANLG IN LVL  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIG OUT RATE  
ANLG IN LVL  
AUTO  
ON  
AUTO  
ON  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
44.1kHz  
44.1kHz  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ENABLED  
BLOCKED  
BLOCKED  
RECORD  
LD MAIN ADV  
CD MAIN ADV  
TUNER MAIN ADV  
AUTO  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
DIGITAL  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
ANALOG  
OFF  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
LD RECORD ADV  
CD RECORD ADV  
TUNER RECORD ADV  
+OdB  
OFF  
44.1kHz  
ENABLED  
+OdB  
OFF  
44.1kHz  
ENABLED  
+OdB  
OFF  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
ANLG IN LVL  
AUTO  
ON  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
44.1kHz  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
COMPONENT OSD  
COMPONENT OSD  
ENABLED  
TV MAIN ADV  
PVR MAIN ADV  
AUX MAIN ADV  
AUTO  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
AUTO  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
DIGITAL  
OFF  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
TV RECORD ADV  
PVR RECORD ADV  
AUX RECORD ADV  
+OdB  
OFF  
44.1kHz  
ENABLED  
+OdB  
OFF  
44.1kHz  
+OdB  
OFF  
44.1kHz  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIG OUT RATE  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIG OUT RATE  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIG OUT RATE  
AUTO  
ON  
S-VIDEO OSD 4:3  
COMPONENT OSD  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
BLOCKED  
ENABLED  
RECORD  
RECORD  
RECORD  
A-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Appendix  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
C
R
O
S
S
OV  
E
R
S
ETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
80Hz  
R
C
SR  
RR  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
M
SUB  
L
SL RL  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
80Hz  
THX SPEAKER SETUP  
THX SETUP  
THX REAR SPEAKERS  
CUSTOM SETUP  
FRONT L/R  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
MONO  
THX 80Hz  
NONE  
!CAUTION!  
PRESSING THE  
BUTTON WILL  
FRONT L/R  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
SUB XOVER  
LFE  
80 Hz  
80 Hz  
80 Hz  
80 Hz  
MONO  
80 Hz  
OFF  
AUTOMATICALLY CHANGE  
THE OUTPUTS TO A THX  
SPEAKER  
ON  
OFF  
SUB XOVER THX 80Hz  
ON  
OFF  
LFE  
OFF  
ULTRA2 SUB OFF  
N/A  
CONFIGURATION  
APART  
CLOSE  
TOGETHER  
ULTRA2 SUB OFF  
BGC  
ASA  
APART  
CLOSE  
TOGETHER  
BGC  
ASA  
N/A  
APART  
APART  
FRONT L/R SPEAKERS  
REAR L/R SPEAKERS  
CENTER SPEAKERS  
SIDE L/R SPEAKERS  
SUBWOOFERS L/R  
SUB XOVER  
FULL  
FULL + SUB  
FULL  
FULL + SUB  
FULL  
FULL + SUB  
FULL  
FULL + SUB  
MONO  
STEREO  
FULL  
30Hz  
30Hz  
40Hz  
30Hz  
30Hz  
30Hz  
NONE  
40Hz  
50Hz  
40Hz  
40Hz  
40Hz  
50Hz  
60Hz  
50Hz  
50Hz  
50Hz  
60Hz  
70Hz  
60Hz  
60Hz  
60Hz  
70Hz  
80Hz  
70Hz  
70Hz  
70Hz  
80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
NONE  
80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
NONE  
80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
110Hz  
120Hz  
NONE  
A-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Lexicon  
MENU TREE (continued)  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
CHECKING FOR SILENCE  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
CHECKING MICROPHONES  
GROUP MICROPHONES  
INTO A BUNDLE IN THE  
MIDDLE OF THE ROOM  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
PLEASE WAIT  
PLEASE WAIT  
DISPLAYS  
MANUAL  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
PRESS  
TO BEGIN  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
MIC CHECK  
When an ERROR mes-  
sage appears on the last  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
screen, press the and  
arrow buttons to high-  
light the desired micro-  
phone. Then, press the  
arrow button to view  
more details about the  
error. One of the mes-  
sages shown to the left  
will appear in the on-  
screen display.  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
(MICROPHONE)  
NOT DETECTED  
or  
(MICROPHONE)  
SIGNAL TOO LOW  
or  
(MICROPHONE)  
OUT OF RANGE  
or  
or  
DISTANCES & LEVELS  
DISTANCES  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MIC 1  
MIC 2  
MIC 3  
MIC 4  
ERROR  
OK  
OK  
OK  
MANUAL  
PLACE MICROPHONES  
IN PRIMARY LISTENING  
POSITIONS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
PRESS  
TO VIEW  
DETAILS  
(MICROPHONE)  
TOO MUCH ROOM NOISE  
(MICROPHONE)  
OK  
When an ERROR message appears on the last CHECK  
MICROPHONES screen, pressing the arrow but-  
ton opens the SPEAKER SETUP menu. When no  
ERROR message appears on the last CHECK MICRO-  
PHONES screen, pressing the arrow button opens  
the AUTO SPEAKER SETUP menu.  
A-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Appendix  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP  
A
U
T
O
SPE  
!CA  
HIGH AU  
YOU WILL E 10 SEC  
TO LEAVE  
SIT QU  
PRESS
A
K
E
R
SETUP  
N!  
EVELS  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DISTANCES & LEVELS  
DISTANCES  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
U
D
TI  
O
L
TEST WILL BEGIN IN  
10  
IO  
MANUAL  
T  
H
A
V
PRESS TO SKIP  
COUNTDOWN  
PLACE MICROPHONES  
IN PRIMARY LISTENING  
POSITIONS  
HE  
R
OOM OR  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
I
E
TLY  
T
O
BEGIN  
MIC CHECK REQUIRED  
FOR AUTO CALIBRATION  
COUNTDOWN  
When the MC-12 is finished calibrating speaker  
distances and output levels, the AUTO SPEAKER  
SETUP results screen shown at the left will open on  
the on-screen display, indicating the results for  
each calibration procedure. Press the and ꢂ  
arrow buttons to highlight the desired calibration  
procedure. Then, press the arrow button to  
select this procedure. Selecting DISTANCES opens  
the AUTO DISTANCES screen shown below.  
Selecting the LEVELS option opens the AUTO LEV-  
ELS screen shown below.  
SETTING DISTANCES  
SETTING LEVELS  
or  
A
U
T
O
SPE  
A
K
E
R
SETUP  
A
U
T
O
SP  
K
E
R
SETUP  
ERROR  
ERROR  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
N/A  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
N/A  
DISTANCES  
LEVELS  
OK  
OK  
DISTANCES  
LEVELS  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
AUTO VALUES APPLIED  
PRESS TO VIEW  
DETAILS  
AUTO VALUES APPLIED  
PRESS TO VIEW  
DETAILS  
LEVELS  
OK  
OK  
N/A  
N/A  
DISTANCES  
The AUTO DISTANCES and AUTO LEVELS screens  
shown at the right indicate the individual calibra-  
tion results for each speaker. Press the and ꢂ  
arrow buttons to highlight the desired speaker cali-  
bration parameter. Then, press the arrow but-  
ton to view more detailed results for the selected  
speaker.  
AUTO LEVELS  
AUTO DISTANCES  
(SPEAKER)  
SPKR OUTPUT TOO HIGH  
(SPEAKER)  
SPEAKER OUT OF PHASE  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
ERROR  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
N/A  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
ERROR  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
N/A  
(SPEAKER)  
SPKR OUTPUT TOO LOW  
(SPEAKER)  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
SIGNAL TOO LOW  
(SPEAKER)  
UNABLE TO CALCULATE  
Press the arrow button to return to the AUTO  
SPEAKER SETUP results screen shown above (right).  
Then, press the arrow button to select the other  
calibration procedure or press the the arrow  
button to return to the SPEAKER SETUP menu.  
(SPEAKER)  
MAY NOT BE ACCURATE  
N/A  
N/A  
(SPEAKER)  
(SPEAKER)  
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED  
(SPEAKER)  
OK  
(SPEAKER)  
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED  
OK  
A-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Lexicon  
MENU TREE (continued)  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP  
A
U
T
O
SPE  
!CA  
HIGH AU  
YOU WILL E 10 SEC  
TO LEAVE  
SIT QU  
PRESS
A
K
E
R
SETUP  
N!  
IOLEVELS  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
DISTANCES & LEVELS  
DISTANCES  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
U
D
TI  
O
TEST WILL BEGIN IN  
10  
MANUAL  
T  
H
A
V
PRESS TO SKIP  
COUNTDOWN  
PLACE MICROPHONES  
IN PRIMARY LISTENING  
POSITIONS  
HE  
R
OOM OR  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
I
E
TLY  
T
O
BEGIN  
MIC CHECK REQUIRED  
FOR AUTO CALIBRATION  
COUNTDOWN  
The AUTO LEVELS screen shown below indicates the  
individual calibration results for each speaker. Press the  
SETTING DISTANCES  
SETTING LEVELS  
The AUTO DISTANCES screen shown below indicates  
the individual calibration results for each speaker. Press  
the and arrow buttons to highlight the desired  
speaker calibration parameter. Then, press the ꢃ  
arrow button to view more detailed results for the  
selected speaker.  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
N/A  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
N/A  
and arrow buttons to highlight the desired  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
speaker calibration parameter. Then, press the ꢃ  
arrow button to view more detailed results for the  
selected speaker.  
N/A  
N/A  
AUTO LEVELS  
AUTO DISTANCES  
(SPEAKER)  
SET DISTANCES  
SET LEVELS  
(SPEAKER)  
SPKR OUTPUT TOO HIGH  
SPEAKER OUT OF PHASE  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
ERROR  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
N/A  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
ERROR  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
N/A  
AUTO DISTANCES  
ORIGINAL DISTANCES  
AUTO LEVELS  
ORIGINAL LEVELS  
(SPEAKER)  
SPKR OUTPUT TOO LOW  
(SPEAKER)  
SIGNAL TOO LOW  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
(SPEAKER)  
OK  
R
C
SR  
RR  
R
SR  
RR  
(SPEAKER)  
UNABLE TO CALCULATE  
0.0ft  
0.0dB  
0.0ft  
0.0dB  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0dB  
C
(SPEAKER)  
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED  
(SPEAKER)  
MAY NOT BE ACCURATE  
0.0dB  
N/A  
M
SUB  
M
SUB  
N/A  
L
SL RL  
0.0ft  
L
SL RL  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
(SPEAKER)  
OK  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
AUTO DISTANCES  
APPLIED  
AUTO LEVELS  
ORIGINAL LEVELS  
APPLIED  
APPLIED  
ORIGINAL DISTANCES  
APPLIED  
(SPEAKER)  
SPEAKER IS NOT ENABLED  
A-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Appendix  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
SPEAKER SETUP  
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
SET CROSSOVERS  
CHECK MICROPHONES  
AUTOMATIC  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
LEVELS CALIBRATION  
INTERNAL NOISE TEST  
EXTERNAL NOISE TEST  
BASS PEAK LIMITER  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
MANUAL  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
R
C
SR  
RR  
60Hz  
SET CROSSOVERS  
BEFORE CALIBRATING  
60Hz  
40Hz  
60Hz  
M
SUB  
L
SL RL  
60Hz  
40Hz  
60Hz  
40Hz  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
0.0ft  
N/A  
BASS PEAK LIMITER  
SPEAKER LEVEL ADJUST  
INTERNAL NOISE  
!CAUTION!  
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS  
CAL NOISE  
ON  
ON  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
FRONT LEFT  
CENTER  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
N/A  
L/R LIMITER  
L/R LIMIT ADJ  
LFE LIMITER’  
LFE LIMIT ADJ  
100dB  
FRONT RIGHT  
SIDE RIGHT  
REAR RIGHT  
REAR LEFT  
SIDE LEFT  
SUB (MONO)  
SUB RIGHT  
LFE  
ON  
100dB  
!CAUTION!  
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS  
N/A  
FEET  
UNITS  
N/A  
0.0 to 30.0ft or 12.0m  
METERS  
FEET  
75 to 120dB  
-18 to 12dB  
ON  
OFF  
A-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Lexicon  
MENU TREE (continued)  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
IN PROGRESS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
MAIN MENU  
SETUP  
!CAUTION!  
HIGH AUDIO LEVELS  
INPUTS  
SPEAKERS  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
DISPLAYS  
VOLUME CONTROLS  
TRIGGERS  
LOCK OPTIONS  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
CALIBRATION DONE  
TEST WILL BEGIN IN  
10  
PRESS TO SKIP  
COUNTDOWN  
YOU WILL HAVE 10 SEC  
TO LEAVE THE ROOM OR  
SIT QUIETLY  
PLEASE WAIT  
PRESS TO CONTINUE  
PRESS TO BEGIN  
COUNTDOWN  
OR  
LIVE! CALIBRATION  
SIGNAL TOO LOW  
PRESS TO CONTINUE  
MAIN MENU  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
BASS  
TREBLE  
TILT EQ  
LOUDNESS  
BALANCE  
FADER  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
OFF  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
<I>  
<I>  
ZONE2 BALANCE  
RECORD BALANCE  
<I>  
<I>  
L<  
<l>  
>R  
B<  
<l>  
>F  
ON  
OFF  
-3.0 to +3.0dB  
-6.0 to +6.0dB  
A-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Appendix  
MODE ADJUST  
FILM  
+
MAIN MENU  
FILM  
PLIIx +  
CATHEDRAL  
MODE ADJUST  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
SETUP  
RE-EQUALIZER  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
AUTO AZIMUTH  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
ON  
CENTER DEPTH  
SPEECH DETECT  
SIZE  
MID RT  
BASS RT  
PRE-DELAY  
ROLLOFF  
EFFECT LVL  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
12  
ON  
30m  
3.72s  
4.47s  
23ms  
3.1kHz  
-8dB  
RE-EQUALIZER  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
TV  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
PLIIx +  
PLIIx MOV  
PLIIx MUS  
PLII +  
PLII MOVIE  
PLII MUSIC  
PL +  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
REAR  
ON  
OFF  
7.0kHz  
CIN  
PLIIx MOV  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
MUSIC  
PLIIx MUS  
PRO LOGIC  
+
Selecting  
a
listening mode  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
PANORAMA  
CTR WIDTH  
DIMENSION  
SURROUND DLY  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
OFF  
3
NEUTRAL  
opens the corresponding lis-  
tening mode menu (pages A-  
14 to A-16). The parameters  
on the left side of the listening  
mode menus differ from mode  
to mode. The parameter set-  
tings on the right side are  
adjustable. The listening mode  
menus shown here indicate  
factory-default parameter set-  
tings for each listening mode.  
Listening mode menu param-  
eter drop-down menus are  
shown on pages A-16 to A-17.  
TV  
PANORAMA  
EFFECT LVL  
BASS CONTENT STEREO  
LOW FREQ WIDTH +0  
SURR ROLLOFF 3.1kHz  
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms  
INPUT BALANCE  
CALIBRATION  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
CIN  
MUSIC  
AUTO AZIMUTH  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
ON  
+4dB  
NIGHTCLUB  
CONCERT HALL  
CHURCH  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
2-CH SURROUND  
2-CHANNEL  
MONO LOGIC  
MONO SURROUND  
MONO  
10ms  
NIGHTCLUB  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
FILM  
OFF  
REAR  
ON  
OFF  
7.0kHz  
CENTER DEPTH  
SPEECH DETECT  
SIZE  
LIVENESS  
PRE-DELAY  
11  
ON  
5m  
PLII +  
<l>  
196ms  
5ms  
9.0kHz  
+3dB  
RE-EQUALIZER  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
ROLLOFF  
EFFECT LVL  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
5.1 FILM  
5.1 TV  
2-CH SURROUND  
PLII MOVIE  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
5.1 MUSIC  
*
MUSIC  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
CONCERT HALL  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
FRONT STEERING MUSIC  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
MUSIC  
CENTER DEPTH  
SPEECH DETECT  
SIZE  
LIVENESS  
PRE-DELAY  
12  
ON  
20m  
1.72ms  
OFF  
2.4kHz  
-2dB  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
DIGITAL*  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
5.1 MONO SURR  
5.1 MONO  
FILM*  
2-CHANNEL  
PLII MUSIC  
NEUTRAL  
+0dB  
ON  
OFF  
7.0kHz  
SUB L/R LVL  
CUSTOM  
PANORAMA  
CTR WIDTH  
DIMENSION  
SURROUND DLY  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
OFF  
3
NEUTRAL  
10ms  
ROLLOFF  
MONO LOGIC  
EFFECT LVL  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
EFFECT LVL  
-9dB  
ON  
3.1kHz  
MUSIC*  
*
ACADMY FILTER  
SURR ROLLOFF  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
PL +  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
CHURCH  
*
RE-EQUALIZER  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
FRONT STEERING MSURR  
SOUND STAGE NEUTRAL  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF 7.0kHz  
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
2-CHAN*  
CENTER DEPTH  
SPEECH DETECT  
SIZE  
5
ON  
20m  
1.56s  
1.87s  
24ms  
2.4kHz  
-3dB  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
FILM  
MUSIC  
*
MONO SURROUND  
ON  
OFF  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
MID RT  
MUSIC  
PRO LOGIC  
BASS RT  
PRE-DELAY  
ROLLOFF  
EFFECT LVL  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
5.1a BYPASS  
2CH BYPASS  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
MONO  
CUSTOM  
SUB L/R LVL  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
LIVE! LARGE  
A-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Lexicon  
MENU TREE (continued)  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
MUSIC  
LIVE! SMALL  
5.1 FILM  
5.1a  
EFFECT LVL  
ACADEMY FILTER  
SURR ROLLOFF 3.1kHz  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
-9dB  
ON  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SURROUND EX  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
AUTO  
OFF  
MID RT  
BASS RT  
ROLLOFF  
TREB CUT RT  
PRE DELAY  
ADVANCED  
CUSTOM  
597ms  
597ms  
3.1kHz  
3.1kHz  
10ms  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SURROUND EX  
LFE MIX  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
FILM  
ON  
REAR  
ON  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
LFE MIX  
+0.0dB  
AUTO  
5.1 MONO SURR  
DECODING  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
OFF  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
5.1a  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
LFE MIX  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
+0.0dB  
LIVE! SMALL ADVANCED  
REVERB LVL +0dB  
EARLY RFLX LVL -13dB  
BASS XOVER  
SHAPE  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
+0.0dB  
5.1 MONO  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
2-CHAN  
SUB L/R LVL  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
CENTER MIX  
SURROUND MIX  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0  
MASTER LEVEL  
LFE MIX  
DECODING  
SUB L/R LVL  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
+0dB  
156Hz  
0
0%  
19m  
5.1a STANDARD  
FILM  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
SPREAD  
SIZE  
5.1 TV  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
+0.0dB  
AUTO  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
EX DECODING  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
AUTO  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
LFE MIX  
FILM  
ON  
REAR  
ON  
OFF  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
+0.0dB  
AUTO  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
FILM  
OFF  
REAR  
ON  
OFF  
LIVE! MED  
+0dB  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
MID RT  
BASS RT  
ROLLOFF  
TREB CUT RT  
PRE DELAY  
ADVANCED  
CUSTOM  
1.84s  
2.76s  
2.4kHz  
3.1kHz  
18ms  
CENTER MIX  
SURROUND MIX  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0  
MASTER LEVEL  
LFE MIX  
+0dB  
+0dB  
5.1a FILM  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
OFF  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
+0dB  
+0.0dB  
+0dB  
FRONT STEERING  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
FILM  
ON  
REAR  
ON  
OFF  
EX DECODING  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
AUTO  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
DECODING  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
+0.0dB  
SUB L/R LVL  
CUSTOM  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
LIVE! MED ADVANCED  
5.1a BYPASS  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
OFF  
MUSIC  
REVERB LVL  
EARLY RFLX LVL -14dB  
BASS XOVER  
SHAPE  
SPREAD  
SIZE  
-4dB  
5.1 MUSIC  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
FRONT STEERING MUSIC  
DIGITAL  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
FRONT STEERING MUSIC  
156Hz  
2
25%  
30m  
+0.0dB  
EX DECODING  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
AUTO  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
LFE MIX  
OFF  
NEUTRAL  
ON  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OFF  
NEUTRAL  
ON  
OFF  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
2CH BYPASS  
NO PARAMETERS  
OFF  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
+0.0dB  
AUTO  
5.1a MUSIC  
LIVE! LARGE  
VOCAL ENHANCE +0.0dB  
FRONT STEERING MUSIC  
LIVE! LARGE ADVANCED  
MID RT  
BASS RT  
ROLLOFF  
TREB CUT RT  
PRE DELAY  
ADVANCED  
CUSTOM  
4.71s  
4.71s  
3.1kHz  
2.4kHz  
20ms  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
REVERB LVL  
EARLY RFLX LVL -17dB  
BASS XOVER  
SHAPE  
SPREAD  
SIZE  
-6dB  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SOUND STAGE  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS ENHANCE  
SURR ROLLOFF  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
OFF  
NEUTRAL  
ON  
OFF  
7.0kHz  
15ms  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
DECODING  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
CENTER MIX  
SURROUND MIX  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES +0  
MASTER LEVEL  
COMPRESSION  
LFE MIX  
SUB L/R LVL  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
+0dB  
156Hz  
2
28%  
38m  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
+0dB  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
RE-EQUALIZER  
LFE MIX  
DECODING  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
ON  
+0.0dB  
AUTO  
OFF  
+0.0dB  
+0dB  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
A-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Appendix  
Selecting the listening mode menu CALIBRATION, OUTPUT LEVELS, or CUSTOM option opens the corresponding menu path shown below. The CALIBRATION option is available  
for the PANORAMA listening mode. The OUTPUT LEVELS and CUSTOM options are available for most listening modes. These menus are identical regardless of which listening  
mode is selected. Listening mode menu parameter drop-down menus are shown below and on the next page.  
MONO LOGIC  
EFFECT LVL  
ACADMY FILTER  
SURR ROLLOFF  
OUTPUT LEVELS 3.1kHz  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM VS PRESET  
RESET MODE  
PANORAMA CALIBRATION  
MONO LOGIC  
EFFECT LVL  
ACADMY FILTER  
SURR ROLLOFF 3.1kHz  
OUTPUT LEVELS 3.1kHz  
CUSTOM  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
PANORAMA  
EFFECT LVL  
BASS CONTENT STEREO  
LOW FREQ WIDTH +0  
SURR ROLLOFF 3.1kHz  
REAR DLY OFFSET 15ms  
INPUT BALANCE  
CALIBRATION  
OUTPUT LEVELS  
CUSTOM  
-9dB  
ON  
+0  
SOURCE LEFT & RIGHT  
SPEAKER ANGLE 30deg  
-9dB  
ON  
CENTER  
SIDE L/R  
REAR L/R  
SUB L/R  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+0dB  
+4dB  
LISTENER POS  
+0  
NOTE:  
ENSURE THAT  
“SPEAKER SETUP” HAS  
BEEN PROPERLY  
PERFORMED  
<I>  
Selecting a listening mode menu parameter opens the corresponding parameter drop-down menu shown below and on the next page. These drop-down menus are identical  
regardless of which listening mode is selected. However, certain parameter ranges differ from listening mode to listening mode.  
5 SPKR ENHANCE  
BASS CONTENT  
CENTER  
OFF, -30 to +12dB  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES  
-127 to +127  
CUSTOM VS PRESET  
DECODING  
ON  
OFF  
BINAURL  
MONO  
AUTO  
ON  
PRESET  
CUSTOM  
STEREO  
OFF  
ACADEMY FILTER  
BASS ENHANCE  
CENTER DEPTH  
COMPRESSION  
EX DECODING  
DIMENSION  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
OFF  
AUTO  
ON  
OFF  
FRONT  
NEUTRAL  
REAR  
0 to 18  
AUTO AZIMUTH  
BASS RT  
CENTER MIX  
CTR WIDTH  
EFFECT LVL  
FRONT STEERING  
-12 to +6dB  
ON  
OFF  
5ms to 48.6s  
-25 to +5dB  
OFF  
MIN,1 to 6, MAX  
MSURR  
MUSIC  
FILM  
A-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Lexicon  
MENU TREE (continued)  
Refer to the Restoring Factory-Default Settings section that begins on page 6-4 for more information.  
FACTORY SETTINGS  
FACTORY SETTINGS  
EXIT  
HAVE BEEN RESTORED  
PRESS ANY KEY  
TO RESTART  
RESTORE DEFAULTS  
Refer to the Status Menus section that begins on page 2-21 for more information.  
2CH STATUS  
D STATUS  
INPUT  
MODE  
CHANNELS  
BIT RATE  
EX ENCODING  
PG1  
D STATUS  
PG2  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
SAMPLE RATE  
2.0 ENCODING  
DIALOG OFFSET  
MIX ROOM  
CENTER MIX LVL  
SURR MIX LVL  
dB  
dB  
L
R
L
C
R
SL  
LFE  
SR  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
-45  
-45  
STATUS  
DIGITAL STATUS  
STATUS  
PG1  
PG2  
2CH BYPASS STATUS  
5.1 ANALOG STATUS  
5.1a BYPASS STATUS  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
INPUT  
MODE  
CHANNELS  
BIT RATE  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
WORD LENGTH  
SAMPLE RATE  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
ENCODING  
dB  
L
C
R
SL  
LFE  
SR  
dB  
L
C
R
SL  
LFE  
SR  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
-45  
-45  
2CH STATUS  
INPUT  
MODE  
INPUT TYPE  
SAMPLE RATE  
L
R
dB  
0
-6  
-15  
-30  
-45  
A-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Appendix  
INPUT BALANCE  
MASTER LEVEL  
-5 to +5dB  
REAR DLY OFFSET  
OFF, 1 to 30ms  
SIZE  
SPEECH DETECT  
SURROUND DLY  
0 to 15ms  
4 to 20 or 30ms  
ON  
OFF  
L<  
<l>  
>R  
LFE MIX  
MID RT  
REAR L/R  
OFF, -30 to 12dB  
SOUND STAGE  
SUB L/R  
SURROUND EX  
OFF, -30 to 12dB  
FRONT  
NEUTRAL  
REAR  
AUTO  
ON  
OFF  
-20.0 or -10.0 to +0.0dB  
24ms to 24.3s  
CENTER MIX  
PANORAMA  
ON  
RESET MODE  
SOURCE  
SUB L/R LVL  
OFF, -30 to 12dB  
SURROUND MIX  
PRESS RIGHT  
TO RESTORE MODE  
-127  
+0  
+127  
RIGHT  
LEFT & RIGHT  
LEFT  
+5 to +5dB  
OFF  
LIVENESS  
PRE-DELAY  
OFF, 1 to 100ms  
ROLLOFF  
SPEAKER ANGLE  
SURROUND ROLLOFF  
VOCAL ENHANCE  
30ms to 20.2s  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
500Hz to 20.0kHz, OFF  
+6.0dB  
+3.0dB  
+0.0dB  
10 to 90deg  
LOW FREQ WIDTH  
-25 to +25  
RE-EQUALIZER  
SIDE L/R  
OFF, -30 to 12dB  
ON  
OFF  
A-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Lexicon  
INSTALLATION WORKSHEET  
INPUT SETUP  
DVD1 DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME TAPE TUNER AUX  
NAME  
DIGITAL IN  
ANALOG IN  
ANLG IN LVL  
VIDEO IN  
COMPONENT IN  
2-CH  
D
5.1a  
MIC  
MAIN ADVANCED  
INPUT SELECT  
ANALOG BYPASS  
S-VIDEO 16:9  
S-VIDEO 4:3 OSD  
COMPONENT OSD  
ZONE2 IN  
RECORD IN  
RECORD ADVANCED  
ANLG IN LVL  
DIGITAL BYPASS  
DIG OUT RATE  
RECORD  
A-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
MC-12  
Appendix  
SPEAKER SETUP  
CUSTOM SETUP  
THX SETUP  
SPEAKER DISTANCES  
LEVELS CALIBRATIONS  
THX 80Hz  
FRONT LEFT/RIGHT  
THX 80Hz  
THX 80Hz  
CENTER  
SIDE LEFT/RIGHT  
REAR LEFT/RIGHT  
SUB LEFT/RIGHT  
SUB XOVER  
LFE  
MONO  
THX 80Hz  
OFF  
ULTRA2SUB  
BGC  
ASA  
UNITS  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS  
CAL NOISE  
L/R LIMITER  
L/R LIMIT ADJ  
LFE LIMITER  
LFE LIMIT ADJ  
REAR PANEL CONFIG  
Circle one.  
VOLUME CONTROL SETUP  
LOCK OPTIONS  
MAIN PWR ON  
MODES  
8 STEREO INPUTS  
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG MUTE LEVEL  
ZONE PWR ON  
AUDIO CONTROL  
SETUP  
REC PWR ON  
MAX VOLUME  
A-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
Appendix  
Lexicon  
INSTALLATION WORKSHEET (continued)  
DISPLAY SETUP  
TRIGGER 1 SETUP  
TRIGGER 2 SETUP  
Circle all parameters set to ON.  
Circle all parameters set to ON.  
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
STATUS  
REMOTE ONLY  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
ZONE2 INPUTS  
RECORD INPUTS  
FILM  
REMOTE ONLY  
DVD1  
DVD2  
LD  
TV  
SAT  
VCR  
CD  
PVR  
GAME  
TAPE  
TUNER  
AUX  
ZONE2 INPUTS  
RECORD INPUTS  
FILM  
2-CH SURROUND  
2-CHANNEL  
MONO LOGIC  
MONO SURROUND  
2-CH SURROUND  
2-CHANNEL  
MONO LOGIC  
MONO SURROUND  
MONO  
POSITION  
FORMAT  
MONO  
5.1  
5.1  
5.1  
FILM  
TV  
MUSIC  
BACKGROUND  
REMOTE STATE  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY  
STATUS  
5.1  
5.1  
5.1  
FILM  
TV  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
DIGITAL EX  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
5.1 MONO SURR  
5.1 MONO  
5.1 PLIIx MOV  
5.1 PLIIx MUS  
DIGITAL EX  
5.1 2-CHANNEL  
5.1 MONO LOGIC  
5.1 MONO SURR  
5.1 MONO  
BRIGHTNESS  
A/V SYNC DELAY  
CUSTOM NAME  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME  
AUDIO CONTROLS  
BASS  
TV  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
PLIIx +  
PLIIx MOV  
PLIIx MUS  
PLII +  
PLII MOVIE  
PLII MUSIC  
PL +  
PRO LOGIC  
+
TV  
MUSIC  
MUSIC SURR  
PLIIx +  
PLIIx MOV  
PLIIx MUS  
PLII +  
PLII MOVIE  
PLII MUSIC  
PL +  
PRO LOGIC  
+
FILM  
MUSIC  
FILM  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
MUSIC  
TREBLE  
2-CHAN  
FILM  
MUSIC  
SurEX  
MUSIC  
2-CHAN  
FILM  
MUSIC  
SurEX  
MUSIC  
TILT EQ  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
5.1a  
LOUDNESS  
BALANCE  
FADER  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
5.1a BYPASS  
2CH BYPASS  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
5.1a STANDARD  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL  
5.1a BYPASS  
2CH BYPASS  
LIVE! SMALL  
LIVE! MED  
CIN  
MUSIC  
NIGHTCLUB  
CONCERT HALL  
CHURCH  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
CIN  
MUSIC  
NIGHTCLUB  
CONCERT HALL  
CHURCH  
CATHEDRAL  
PANORAMA  
ZONE2 BALANCE  
RECORD BALANCE  
LIVE! LARGE  
LIVE! LARGE  
A-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Index  
Numerics  
A
B
2.0 ENCODING parameter, 2-25  
2CH  
status menu, 2-21  
A/V SYNC DELAY parameter, 3-61, A-22  
about the MC-12, 1-2  
AC input connector, 2-7  
BALANCE parameter, 4-2, 4-7, A-22  
balanced audio output connectors, 2-9  
BASS CONTENT parameter, 5-12, 5-37  
BASS ENHANCE parameter, 5-55-6, 5-165-17,  
frequency response graph, 4-3  
ACADEMY FILTER parameter, 5-15, 5-23, 5-37  
advanced speaker array, 3-32  
ANALOB BYPASS parameter, 3-15  
analog audio input connectors, 2-7  
ANALOG BYPASS parameter, 3-16, A-20  
ANALOG IN parameter, 3-73-8, A-20  
anamorphic trigger signals, 3-16  
ANLG IN LVL parameter, 3-7, 3-9, 3-20  
2CH BYPASS  
status menu, 2-23  
2CH BYPASS listening mode, 5-33  
2-CH SURROUND listening mode, 5-15  
2-CHANNEL listening mode, 5-15  
5 SPKR ENHANCE parameter, 5-55-6, 5-165-17,  
BASS PEAK LIMITERS menu, 3-52, 3-57, A-21  
BASS RT parameter, 5-12, 5-37  
BASS XOVER parameter, 5-37  
5 STEREO & 5.1 ANLG option, 3-60  
5.1 2-CHANNEL listening mode, 5-22  
5.1 ANALOG STATUS menu, 2-22  
5.1 L7 FILM listening mode, 2-18, 5-4, 5-16  
5.1 L7 MUSIC listening mode, 5-4, 5-17  
5.1 L7 TV listening mode, 5-4, 5-17  
5.1 MONO listening mode, 5-23  
5.1 MONO LOGIC listening mode, 5-23  
5.1 MONO SURR listening mode, 5-23  
5.1a 2-CHANNEL listening mode, 5-32  
5.1a BYPASS  
ASA parameter, 3-26  
battery installation  
remote control, 1-6  
BGC parameter, 3-26, 3-32  
BIT RATE parameter, 2-22, 2-25  
BLUE button. See remote control, 2-16  
boundary gain compensation, 3-32  
BRIGHTNESS parameter, 3-65, A-22  
assigning input connectors, 3-7  
AUDIO CNTRL parameter, 3-70, A-21  
AUDIO CONTROLS menu, 4-2, A-22  
audio input connectors  
5.1-channel analog, 2-7  
analog, 2-7  
audio output connectors  
balanced, 2-9  
record zone analog, 2-9  
record zone digital, 2-9  
C
CAL NOISE parameter, 3-573-58, A-21  
Calibration  
5.1a L7 FILM listening mode, 5-4, 5-28  
5.1a L7 MUSIC listening mode, 5-4, 5-29  
5.1a STANDARD listening mode, 5-31  
5.1a THX listening mode, 5-4, 5-30  
5.1a THX MUSIC listening mode, 5-31  
5.1a THX SurEX listening mode, 5-30  
5.1a THX ULTRA2 listening mode, 5-30  
5.1-channel analog audio input connectors, 2-7  
manual, 3-52  
output levels, 3-33  
speaker distances, 3-33  
AUTO AZIMUTH parameter, 5-5, 5-37  
AUTO DISTANCES, 3-49  
AUTO GAIN parameter, 3-93-10  
AUTO LEVELS, 3-49  
AUTO parameter, 3-93-10  
AUTO SPEAKER SETUP screens, 3-47  
Automatic Calibration, 3-35  
CALIBRATION parameter, 5-12, 5-37  
CATHEDRAL listening mode, 5-12  
CENTER DEPTH parameter, 5-105-11, 5-38  
CENTER MIX LVL parameter, 2-25  
8 STEREO INPUTS option, 3-59, A-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Lexicon  
Dolby Digital status menu, 2-21  
FP button. See remote control, 2-16  
FRONT L/R parameter, 3-263-28, 3-30, 3-34  
front panel  
C (continued)  
DOLBY PLII + THX listening mode, 5-4, 5-75-8  
DOLBY PLII MOVIE listening mode, 5-4, 5-7  
DOLBY PLII MUSIC listening mode, 5-8  
DOLBY PLIIx + THX listening mode, 5-7  
DOLBY PLIIx MOV listening mode, 5-7, 5-20  
DOLBY PLIIx MUS listening mode, 5-8, 5-20  
DOLBY PRO LOGIC listening mode, 5-9  
changing input names, 3-5  
CHECK MICROPHONES option, 3-35, 3-39  
CHURCH listening mode, 5-12  
CNTR DLY SAMPLES parameter, 5-22, 5-28, 5-32, 5-38  
COMPONENT IN menu, 3-11  
MC-12 Balanced, 2-4  
FRONT PANEL DISPLAY menu, 3-65  
FRONT STEERING parameter, 5-55-6, 5-40  
COMPONENT IN parameter, 3-7  
DTS listening mode, 5-27  
COMPONENT OSD parameter, 3-15, 3-18, A-20  
CONCERT HALL listening mode, 5-11  
crossover points, determining, 3-223-24, 3-28, 3-30  
CROSSOVER SETUP menu, 3-25  
CTR WIDTH parameter, 5-8, 5-38  
DTS Neo:6 CIN listening mode, 5-10  
DTS Neo:6 FILM listening mode, 5-4  
DTS Neo:6 MUSIC listening mode, 5-10, 5-14  
DTS status menu, 2-22  
DTS THX MUSIC listening mode, 5-27  
DTS THX UL2 Cin listening mode, 5-26  
DTS-ES DECODING parameter, 5-24  
DTS-ES L7 FILM listening mode, 3-12, 5-4, 5-24  
DTS-ES L7 MUSIC listening mode, 5-4, 5-25  
DTS-ES listening mode, 5-4, 5-27  
H
highlights, MC-12, 1-4  
high-pass filter, 3-23  
horizontal bar graphs, 2-12  
CUSTOM parameter, 5-38  
CUSTOM VS PRESET option, 5-35, 5-38  
I
DTS-ES parameter, 3-12, 3-14  
DTS-ES THX listening mode, 5-4, 5-26  
INPUT BALANCE parameter, 5-12, 5-40  
input connectors  
D
digital audio, 2-7  
Declaration of Conformity, A-4  
DIALOG OFFSET parameter, 2-25  
DIG OUT RATE parameter, 3-20, A-20  
digital audio input connectors, 2-7  
DIGITAL BYPASS parameter, 3-20, A-20  
DIGITAL IN parameter, 3-7  
E
EARLY RFLX LVL parameter, 5-39  
EDIT CUSTOM NAME parameter, 3-613-62, A-22  
EDIT INPUT NAME menu, 3-5  
ES ENCODING parameter, 2-212-22, 2-25  
EX DECODING parameter, 5-205-22, 5-39  
EX ENCODING parameter, 2-25  
INPUT NAME menu, 3-5  
INPUT SELECT parameter, 3-153-17, A-20  
Record Zone, 2-5  
DIMENSION parameter, 5-8, 5-38  
DISTANCES & LEVELS option, 3-35, 3-47  
DISTANCES option, 3-47  
INPUT TYPE parameter, 2-212-24, 2-26  
INPUTS  
changing names, 3-5  
F
Dolby DIGITAL EX listening mode, 5-215-22  
Dolby DIGITAL listening mode, 5-4, 5-215-22  
Dolby DIGITAL parameter, 3-123-13  
factory-default settings, restoring, 6-4  
FADER parameter, 4-2, A-22  
Record Zone, 3-2  
installation considerations, 1-5  
I-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Index  
LOW FREQ WIDTH parameter, 5-12, 5-41  
low-pass filter, 3-23  
MONO SUB parameter, 3-34  
MONO SURROUND listening mode, 5-16  
MUTE LEVEL parameter, 3-66, A-21  
I (continued)  
installation worksheet, A-20  
Internal Noise Test, 3-52  
IR input connector, 2-10  
IR receiver, 2-3  
M
MAIN ADV menu, 3-15  
MAIN menu, 2-11  
MAIN PWR ON parameter, 3-66, A-21  
Main Zone, 2-19  
main zone audio output connectors, 2-7  
L
N
L/R LIMIT ADJ parameter, 3-573-58, A-21  
L/R LIMITER parameter, 3-573-58, A-21  
NIGHTCLUB listening mode, 5-10  
L7 FILM listening mode, 2-18, 3-12, 5-5  
L7 MUSIC listening mode, 5-4, 5-6  
L7 MUSIC SURR listening mode, 5-6  
L7 TV listening mode, 5-45-5  
LEDs, IR receiver, 2-3  
manual audio adjustments, 3-10  
manual calibration, 3-52  
MANUAL parameter, 3-93-10  
MANUAL SPEAKER SETUP menu, 3-52  
MASTER LEVEL parameter, 5-22, 5-28, 5-32, 5-41  
MC-12  
O
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY menu, 3-63, A-22  
OSD button. See remote control, 2-16  
output connectors  
level meters, 3-10  
LEVELS CALIBRATION, A-21  
LEVELS CALIBRATION menu, 3-54  
LEVELS option, 3-35  
highlights, 1-4  
Output Level Parameters, 3-33  
OUTPUT LEVELS menu, 5-35  
Output levels, calibrating  
Levels option, 3-47  
product registration, 1-5  
MENU button, 2-17  
menu item selection, 2-11  
menu navigation, 2-11  
selecting, 2-12  
LFE LIMIT ADJ parameter, 3-57, 3-59  
LFE LIMITER parameter, 3-573-58  
LISTENER POS parameter, 5-13, 5-40  
listening mode descriptions, 5-5  
listening mode parameter descriptions, 5-37  
LISTENING MODES  
Bass Peak Limiters, 3-57  
manual, 3-54  
parameters, 3-33  
Menu tree, A-5  
MIC parameter, 3-14  
P
Preferred, 5-3  
MICROPHONE CHECK option, 3-35  
microphone input connectors, 2-10  
microphone placement, 3-41  
MID RT parameter, 5-12, 5-41  
MIX ROOM parameter, 2-21, 2-26  
MODE ADJUST menu, 5-2  
MODES parameter, 3-70, A-21  
MONO LOGIC listening mode, 5-15  
PANORAMA  
calibration, 5-13  
PANORAMA parameter, 5-8, 5-41  
parameter drop-down menus, 2-12  
parameters  
listening modes, preferred, 3-12  
LIVE! CALIBRATION menu, 3-3  
LIVE! mode, 5-33  
listening mode menu, 5-37  
program operation, 3-68  
LIVE! Status Menu, 2-24  
LIVENESS parameter, 5-11, 5-41  
LOCK OPTIONS menu, 3-3, A-21  
LOUDNESS parameter, 4-2, 4-6  
parameters, preferred listening mode selection, 3-12  
I-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Lexicon  
Main Zone, 2-14  
operation considerations, 2-10  
overview, 2-10  
Record Zone, 2-14  
SPEECH DETECT parameter, 5-105-11, 5-43  
SPREAD parameter, 5-43  
standby button, 2-3  
P (continued)  
PLIIx MOV listening mode, 5-20  
PLIIx MUS listening mode, 5-20  
POSITION parameter, 3-63  
power switch, 2-7  
PRE-DELAY parameter, 5-10, 5-12, 5-41  
program operation parameters, 3-683-69  
STATUS menu descriptions, 2-21  
STATUS menu Level Meters, 2-26  
STATUS parameter, 3-63, 3-65  
SUB L/R LVL parameter, 5-32  
SUB L/R parameter, 3-26  
SUB parameter, 5-35  
REMOTE STATE parameter, 3-633-64, A-22  
removable access panel, 2-10  
RESTORE DEFAULT NAME menu, 3-63-7  
restoring factory-default settings, 6-4  
ROLLOFF parameter, 5-11, 5-42  
R
REAR DLY OFFSET parameter, 5-55-6, 5-12, 5-16–  
REAR LEFT parameter, 3-34  
SUB RIGHT parameter, 3-34  
SUB XOVER parameter, 3-26, 3-28, 3-30  
SUBWOOFER parameter, 3-30  
SUBWOOFERS L/R parameter, 3-28  
rear panel  
MC-12 Balanced, 2-8  
REAR RIGHT parameter, 3-34  
REC BALANCE parameter, 4-2  
RECORD ADVANCED menu, 3-20, A-20  
RECORD ADVANCED parameter, 3-15  
RECORD BALANCE parameter, 4-7, A-22  
Record parameter, 3-21  
SURROUND DLY parameter, 5-8, 5-44  
SURROUND EX parameter, 5-19, 5-30, 5-44  
SURROUND MIX parameter, 5-22, 5-28, 5-32, 5-44  
S-VIDEO 16  
S
S:VIDEO 16:9 parameter, 3-15  
S:VIDEO OSD 4:3 parameter, 3-15  
safety instructions, ii, v  
SAMPLE RATE parameter, 2-212-22, 2-24, 2-26  
SET DISTANCES display, 3-50  
SET LEVELS display, 3-50  
SETTING DISTANCES screen, 3-48  
SETTING LEVELS screen, 3-48  
SETUP parameter, 3-70  
SHAPE parameter, 5-42  
SIDE LEFT parameter, 3-34  
SIDE RIGHT parameter, 3-34  
SOUND STAGE parameter, 5-55-6, 5-43  
SOURCE parameter, 5-13, 5-43  
SPEAKER ANGLE parameter, 5-13, 5-43  
speaker calibration parameters, 3-33  
SPEAKER SETUP menu, 3-2  
9 parameter, 3-16  
T
Record Zone, 2-19  
THX SPEAKER SETUP screen, 3-25  
THX SurEX listening mode, 5-18  
THX ULTRA2 listening mode, 5-18, 5-295-30  
THX ULTRA2 SUB parameter, 3-26, 3-31  
TILT EQ parameter, 4-2, 4-5  
TREBLE parameter, 4-2, 4-4  
trigger output connectors, 2-10  
TRIGGER SETUP menu, 3-2  
troubleshooting, 6-2  
record zone audio output connectors, 2-9  
record zone video output connectors, 2-9  
remote control  
battery installation, 1-6  
BLUE button, 2-16  
command bank activation, 2-13  
Two-line Status  
input selection buttons, 2-14  
I-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MC-12  
Index  
T (continued)  
Record Zone, 2-20  
U
USE LAST setting, 3-13  
V
VIDEO IN menu, 3-11  
video input connectors  
S-video, 2-9  
record zone, 2-9  
S-video, 2-9  
VOCAL ENHANCE parameter, 5-55-6, 5-165-17, 5-  
VOLUME CONTROL SETUP menu, 3-2  
volume knob, 2-3  
W
WORD LENGTH parameter, 2-26  
Z
ZONE PWR ON parameter, 3-66  
ZONE2 BALANCE parameter, 4-2, 4-7  
ZONE2 IN parameter, 3-15, 3-183-19  
Zones, About, 2-19  
I-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Inside Back Cover.fm Page 1 Monday, May 9, 2005 11:21 AM  
PRODUCT REGISTRATION  
Please register this product within 15 days of  
purchase. To do so, complete and return this card  
or register online at www.lexicon.com. Retain the  
sales receipt for proof of coverage.  
Mr.  
Mrs.  
Ms.  
Miss  
Single  
Married  
Divorced  
Widowed  
LIMITED WARRANTY  
First Name  
Last Name  
Title  
Company  
Mailing Address  
City  
What Expenses will Harman Specialty Group  
Assume?  
Harman Specialty Group will pay all labor and material  
expenses for covered items. Payment of shipping  
charges is discussed in the next section of the warranty.  
Harman Specialty Group offers the following warranty  
on this product:  
What Certain Damages are Excluded?  
State  
Fax Number  
Zip  
Harman Specialty Group’s liability for a defective  
product is limited to repair or replacement of that  
product, at our option. Harman Specialty Group shall  
not be liable for damages based on inconvenience;  
loss of use of the product; loss of time; interrupted  
operation; commercial loss; or any other damages,  
whether incidental, consequential, or otherwise.  
Telephone Number  
Email Address  
Product Model  
Version  
What is the Duration of this Warranty?  
This warranty will remain in effect for three (3) years  
from the original date of purchase.  
Purchase Date  
Serial Number  
Where did you purchase this product?  
Age Education  
High School  
How is Service Obtained?  
Household Income  
Under $20,000  
When this product needs service, write, telephone, or  
fax Harman Specialty Group to request information  
about where the unit should be taken or sent. When  
making a written request, please include your name,  
complete address, and daytime telephone number;  
the product model and serial numbers; and a descrip-  
tion of the problem. Do not return the unit to Harman  
Specialty Group without prior authorization.  
Under 18  
18-24  
25-34  
35-49  
50-64  
65+  
Who is Covered?  
College  
Graduate School  
Certificate:  
$20,000 to $34,999  
$35,000 to $49,000  
$50,000 to $74,999  
$75,000 to $99,000  
$100,000+  
This warranty may be enforced by the original pur-  
chaser and subsequent owners during the warranty  
period, provided the original dated sales receipt or  
other proof of warranty coverage is presented at time  
of service.  
How do State Laws Relate to this Warranty?  
Some states do not allow limitations on the duration of  
implied warranties and/or the exclusion or limitation  
of incidental or consequential damages. As such, the  
above limitations may not apply.  
How did you learn about this product? Choose one:  
Friend  
Colleague  
Teacher  
Store salesperson  
Store display  
Received as a gift  
Advertisement  
Magazine Article  
Own other Lexicon  
products  
What is Covered?  
This warranty is not enforceable outside of North  
America. This warranty provides specific legal rights.  
Additional rights may be provided by some states.  
This warranty covers all defects in material and  
workmanship on this product, except as specified  
below. The following are not covered:  
When Shipping a Product for Service . . .  
Which of the following were most important in the selection of this product?  
1. Pay any initial shipping charges, which are the  
responsibility of the owner. If necessary repairs are  
covered by this warranty, Harman Specialty  
Group will pay return shipping charges to any  
destination in the United States using the carrier  
of our choice.  
Sound  
Features  
Quality  
Brandname  
Value for price  
Other:  
Durability  
1. Damage resulting from  
What are your three favorite magazines?  
1. 2.  
What are your three favorite websites?  
1. 2.  
A. Accident, misuse, abuse, or neglect.  
B. Failure to follow instructions contained in the  
3.  
3.  
user guide.  
C. Repair or attempted repair unauthorized by  
Harman Specialty Group.  
D. Failure to perform recommended periodic  
What features would you like to see added to this product in the future?  
2. Pack the unit securely. Package insurance is  
strongly recommended.  
maintenance.  
3. Include a copy of the original dated sales receipt.  
(A copy of the original dated sales receipt must be  
presented whenever warranty service is required.)  
4. Do not include accessories such as power cords or  
user guides unless instructed to do so.  
MC-12 05/05  
2. Causes other than product defects, including lack  
of skill, competence, or experience on the part of  
the owner.  
3. Damage occurring during any shipment of this  
product. Claims for shipping damages must be  
made with the carrier.  
4. Damage to a unit that has been altered, or on  
which the serial number has been defaced, modi-  
fied, or removed.  
What are the Limitations of Implied  
Warranties?  
Any implied warranties, including warranties of mer-  
chantability and fitness for a particular purpose, are  
limited in duration to the length of this warranty.  
Customer Service  
Tel 781-280-0300  
Fax 781-280-0495 (Sales)  
Fax 781-280-0499 (Service)  
Harman Specialty Group  
3 Oak Park  
Bedford, MA 01730-1413  
Tel 781-280-0300  
Fax 781-280-0490  
www.lexicon.com  
USA  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A Harman International Company  
Part No. 070-14773 | Rev 4 | 05/05  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

LG Electronics Washer WM3988H User Manual
Lightolier Indoor Furnishings 0889 User Manual
Lightolier Indoor Furnishings TSL User Manual
Lowrance electronic SONAR X100C User Manual
Madrigal Imaging Stereo Amplifier N380 User Manual
Magnadyne DVD Player MV DVD PL3 User Manual
Master Chef Charcoal Grill 85 1035 0 User Manual
Melissa Ventilation Hood 258 001 User Manual
Mellerware Electric Shaver 20610 User Manual
Microsoft Computer Accessories 7706368 User Manual